Professional Documents
Culture Documents
E7030-1001 - R2 - SAMOS AE System User's Manual PDF
E7030-1001 - R2 - SAMOS AE System User's Manual PDF
E7030-1001 - R2 - SAMOS AE System User's Manual PDF
SAMOS AE SYSTEM
USER'S MANUAL
Rev 2
May 2005
Part # : 7030 1001
HQTS: 195 Clarksville Road Princeton Jct., NJ 08550-5303 Telephone: (609) 716-4000 Fax: (609) 716-0706
Internet: www.pacndt.com Email: sales@pacndt.com Subsidiaries: Athens Bahia Bahrain Beijing Buenos Aires
Cambridge Kuala Lumpur Moscow Munich Navi Mumbai Paris Rotterdam So Paulo Tokyo
Field Offices: Los Angeles, CA Kalamazoo, MI Houston, TX
www.pacndt.com
PRODUCT WARRANTY
MISTRAS Holdings Group warrants products of its manufacture to be free from
defects in design, workmanship and material under normal use and service for a
period of One year (twelve (12) months), after the date of shipment, and ninety
(90) days in the case of transducer products. MHG will repair or replace free of
charge (excluding freight/shipping charges) all defective parts in systems which are
returned to the factory in Princeton Junction, New Jersey, U.S.A. (or MHG
Authorized Repair Center) (freight prepaid), within the above applicable warranty
period; and provided that our inspection discloses that the defects are as specified as
above, and provided further that the equipment has not been altered or repaired other
than with authorization from MHG and by its approved procedures, not been subject
to misuse, abuse, improper maintenance, negligence or accident, damaged by
excessive current or otherwise had its serial number or any part thereof altered,
defaced or removed and warranty stickers are in place. All defective items released
hereunder shall become the property of the seller.
OEM parts used in MHG systems or sold as accessories will be warranted for six (6)
months. OEM items include monitors, printers, modems and non-MHG
manufactured computer items and ninety (90) days in the case of flexible disks, hard
disk drives and battery packs.
Group Headquarters:
195 Clarksville Road
Princeton Junction, NJ 08550
Phone: (609) 716-4000 Fax: (609) 716-0706
7/10/06
2.
LICENSE
1.
MHG grants CUSTOMER the right to use the SOFTWARE on a single
COMPUTER at a single location so long as CUSTOMER complies with the terms
of the LICENSE and either destroys or returns the SOFTWARE when
CUSTOMER no longer has this right.
2.
CUSTOMER may not transfer the program electronically from one computer to
another over a network, unless licensed to do so. An acceptable license can
include the purchase of additional software licenses or the use of a purchased
electronic License key which is plugged into one computer to activate the license.
3.
MHG shall have the right to terminate this license(s) if CUSTOMER violates any
of its provisions. CUSTOMER owns the storage media (CD, diskette(s), etc.)
purchased, but under the Copyright Law MHG continues to own the SOFTWARE
recorded on it and all copies of it.
4.
CUSTOMER agrees to make no more than one (1) copy of the SOFTWARE for
backup purposes and to place a label on the outside of the backup CD or diskette,
showing the serial number, program name, version number and the MHG
copyright and trademark notices on the same form as the original copy.
5.
CUSTOMER agrees to pay for licenses for additional user copies of the
SOFTWARE if CUSTOMER intends to or does use it on more than one
COMPUTER.
3.
TRANSFER OR REPRODUCTION
CUSTOMER understands that unauthorized reproduction of copies of the SOFTWARE
and/or unauthorized transfer of any copy may be a serious crime, as well as subjecting a
CUSTOMER to damages and attorney fees. CUSTOMER may not transfer any copy of
the SOFTWARE to another person unless CUSTOMER transfers all copies, including the
original, and advises MHG of the name and address of that person, who must agree in
writing to the terms of this LICENSE in order to use the SOFTWARE. MHG has the
right to terminate the LICENSE, to trace serial numbers, and to take legal action if these
conditions are violated.
4.
Customer may not reverse engineer any of the software or information provided.
5.
DISTRIBUTION OR SALES
Distribution or sale of any software incorporating the MISTRAS Holdings Group or any
of its companies Software or Drivers is illegal without a signed and executed Software
Distribution License Agreement.
6.
LIMITED WARRANTY
The only warranty MHG makes is that the media on which the SOFTWARE is recorded
will be replaced without charge, if MHG in good faith determines that the media was
defective and not subject to misuse, and if returned to MHG, within thirty days of
purchase. MHG reserves the right to change the specifications and operating
characteristics of the SOFTWARE it produces, over a period of time, without notice.
7.
8.
MISCELLANEOUS
This license agreement supplements the purchase order.
It cannot and shall not be
modified by purchase orders, advertising or other representations of anyone, unless a
written amendment has been signed by one of our company officers.
When
CUSTOMER opens the SOFTWARE package or uses the SOFTWARE, this act shall be
considered as mutual agreement to the terms of this LICENSE. This LICENSE shall be
governed by New Jersey law, except as to copyright matters which are covered by
Federal laws, and is deemed entered into at Princeton Junction, New Jersey by both
parties.
SAMOS Workstations
advanced and affordable
PCI-8 Subsystems occupy one full-size PCI slot in a computer
chassis and can be implemented inside most standard PCs
or inside one of PACs four (4) rugged, multi-channel SAMOS
system chassis, including SAMOS 64/48/32 and SAMOS.
Such systems are based on PACs known parallel processing architecture, processing simultaneously waveforms and
AE features and are extremely cost competitive for todays
advanced digital AE market. As with all other PAC systems,
SAMOS multi-channel systems are powered by the AE experienced based Windows PACwin Software Suite operating
at outstanding waveform/features AE hit data rates.
. . .SAMOS 32
The SAMOS 32 AE system is geared for laboratory or field
use, holding up to 4 PCI-8 cards for up to 32 AE channels of
operation. Based on a heavy-duty desktop PC computer chassis, the SAMOS 32 has added features for reliable day-to-day
operation, including extra cooling, ventilation and the latest
powerful
PC
computer. The
most economical,
high
performance AE
system available
today,
the
SAMOS 32 is
ideal for users
with tight system
budgets.
Retaining all the
features of a full
size AE system,
including activity
. . .SAMOS 48
SAMOS 48 is a portable AE system, equipped with a handle
for carrying and an integral keyboard built within the hinged
front protective cover. Weighing less than 38 pounds with all
48 channels, the SAMOS 48 is 21 long x 14 wide x 7.6
tall. Inside this small enclosure is a powerful PC computer,
large hard disk, floppy drive, R/W CD/DVD drive and the standard complement of parallel printer port, serial port, USB and
mouse port. Built-in AE features include a digitally controlled
audio monitor, up to 8 parametrics and AE Hit indicator LEDs.
Expansion and communication options include Ethernet LAN
option and optional modem for remote control and communications purposes. Both Internet and Intranet software and
interfaces are available.
. . .SAMOS 64
SAMOS 64 is a large
capacity 64-channel system and represents the
industrys largest number
of AE channels in a single
enclosure.
The system comes
equipped with an advanced PC based CPU
and all standard peripherals including a LAN
connection. Multiple cooling systems make
SAMOS 64 a rugged
multi-channel system esFigure 4. SAMOS-64 AE System.
pecially for demanding
applications in harsh environments.
Standard 32-bit PCI hardware and 32-bit software allow the customer maximum flexibility of using a PC or a notebook computer.
No need to change home made PCs, but ability to take advantage
of today's PC speeds readily available with high-performance PCI
busses. Multiple AE channels are easily synchronized for multiple
location algorithms.
tasking, etc.
Key Features . . .of the PCI-8 boards for SAMOS Multi-Channel AE Systems
" 8 complete (16-bit A/D) digital channels of AE features and
"
"
"
"
"
grid
" Opaque
or Transparent
(100%), to view events in rear
of sphere
" Data cursor for coordinates
without the guesswork
" Easy sensor, weld & nozzle
placement per ASME code
" Pick sphere, sensor and data
colors
"
"
"
"
point plots, histograms, multiple plots within a graph, waveforms, FFTs, and more
Arrange multiple graphs on a screen (as many as you like)
Zooming, panning, cursor readout
Location modes (Zonal, Linear, Planar, 3D-LOC)
Hit and Event linking to other graphs
SAMOS Software. . . supported by PACs AE multichannel systems experience since the early 70s
"
"
"
"
"
"
"
"
"
"
"
Extracted AE Features:
Physical Specifications:
Size:
Weight:
Power Consumption:
DC Power:
Electrical Specifications:
AE Inputs:
Input Impedance:
Preamplifier Power:
Sensor Testing:
Frequency Response:
8 channels
50 Ohms
DAC controlled voltage for
preamplifier gain control with
the 1222 LF family of preamplifiers
AST built-in
1 kHz - 200 kHz (at -3 dB points)
Signal Processing:
AE Signal Gain:
Filters:
0, 6, 12 dB computer selectable
4 High Pass computer selectable
filters - 1 kHz, 5.0 kHz, 20 kHz,
100 kHz, 4th order Butterworth
4 Low Pass computer selectable
filters - 10 kHz, 40 kHz, 100 kHz,
200 kHz, 4th order Butterworth
Max. Signal Amplitude: Up to 100 dB AE; Up to 99 dB ASL
ADC Type:
16 bit, 1.0 MSPS per channel
maximum
Waveform Sample Rate: Computer selectable, 100 kS/s,
200kS/s, 500kS/s, 1M-Samples/
second
Analog Parametrics:
Parametric Channels:
2 per board
Parametric A/D Res.:
16 bits
Parametric Sample Rate: 10 kHz sample rate for each
analog parametric
Time Driven Data Rate: Controlled by software
10 msec. to 60 seconds
Time Parametrics:
All parametrics are available in
time data set
Additional I/O:
Digital I/O:
8 Digital Inputs, 8 Digital Outputs
Audio Monitor Interface: Analog switch and buffer to select
desired channels to be routed to
PAC audio monitor board
LED Activity Monitor:
On board LED driver to directly drive
LEDs on front panel. LED minimum on-time is 0.05 seconds
HQTS: 195 Clarksville Road Princeton Jct., NJ 08550 Phone: (609) 716-4000 Fax: (609) 716-0706 Email: sales@pacndt.com
Internet: www.pacndt.com Subsidiaries: Cambridge (44) 1954-231612 Paris (33) (1) 4982-6040 Tokyo (81) (3) 3498-3570
So Paulo (55) (11) 3082-5111 Athens (30) (210) 284-6801 Moscow (7095) 200-39-85 Beijing (86) (10) 8497-3570 Buenos
Aires (54) (11) 4345-0400 Wolfegg (49) (75) 272312 Rotterdam (31) (10) 245 0325 Representatives: Worldwide.
SAMOS AE System
USER'S MANUAL
Rev. 2
Index
(pages 1 - 33)
1
2
8
13
19
2
4
11
12
Introduction - AE Sensors
Detection of Acoustic Emission Signals
AE Transfer Coupling
Integral Preamplifier Sensors
Preamplifier Introduction
Auto Sensor Testing
1224 Series Repeater Amplifier
1
1
2
3
5
20
22
AE GENERAL PRACTICES
APPENDICES
1.
2.
3.
Copyright 2005, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Junction, New Jersey, USA
1
7
8
66
112
116
116
CHAPTER I
INTRODUCTION
Rev. 2
Chapter I Introduction
SAMOS AE SYSTEM
USER'S MANUAL
Chapter I INTRODUCTION
Table of Contents
Chapter I - INTRODUCTION....................................................................................................................................... 1
1. ACOUSTIC EMISSION AND ITS APPLICATIONS.................................................................................... 1
2. OVERVIEW OF THE PCI-8 SYSTEM ............................................................................................................. 2
2.1
SAMOS AE System Block Diagram.......................................................................................................... 4
2.2
Overview of the PCI-8 Card ......................................................................................................................... 6
2.3
PCI-8 Card Block Diagram Description:................................................................................................... 7
3. TERMINOLOGY USED IN THIS MANUAL AND THE AE INDUSTRY.............................................. 8
3.1.1
Glossary of Acoustic Emission Terms ............................................................................................ 10
3.1.1.1
Key Terms in Logical Order......................................................................................................... 10
3.1.1.2
All Terms in Alphabetical Order.................................................................................................. 10
4. AVAILABLE CONFIGURATIONS................................................................................................................ 13
4.1
Standard Hardware Components ............................................................................................................... 13
4.2
Number of Channels .................................................................................................................................... 13
4.3
SAMOS AE System, Internal Computer Configurations...................................................................... 14
4.4
Sensor, Preamplifier and Connecting Cables .......................................................................................... 14
4.5
Frequency Filtering...................................................................................................................................... 15
4.5.1 Using a Filters.set File .................................................................................................................................... 16
4.6
Standard Software Supplied ....................................................................................................................... 17
4.7
Optional Software ........................................................................................................................................ 17
4.7.1
AEwin Options.................................................................................................................................... 18
4.7.2
Additional Optional Programs for SAMOS AE systems ............................................................. 19
5. SPECIFICATIONS ............................................................................................................................................... 20
5.1
SAMOS AE System Specifications (Preliminary and Subject to change):........................................ 20
5.2
PCI-8 Board Specifications (subject to change):.................................................................................. 21
5.3
PCI-8 Board and Bracket Connections..................................................................................................... 23
5.4
PCI-8 On-Board Connector Description.................................................................................................. 23
5.4.1
J-5 Audio Connector Description and Pin-out .............................................................................. 23
5.4.2
J-8 Hit LED Connector Description and Pin-out............................................................................. 24
5.4.3
J-6 Parametric and Digital I/O Connector Description and Pin-out ........................................... 24
5.4.4
J-4 Real Time Control Connector Description................................................................................. 25
5.5
PCI-8 Board Addressing............................................................................................................................. 26
5.6
Upgrading FPGA Firmware on PCI-8 Boards........................................................................................ 26
5.7
AE Signal Processing Features and Specifications................................................................................ 27
5.7.1
AE Hit Driven Features Descriptions.............................................................................................. 28
5.7.2
Real Time Frequency Features ......................................................................................................... 32
5.7.2.1
Partial Power Setup:....................................................................................................................... 32
5.7.2.2
Partial Power Presentation:........................................................................................................... 34
5.7.3
Time Driven AE Data......................................................................................................................... 34
Copyright 2005, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Junction, New Jersey, USA
Rev. 2
Chapter I Introduction
Chapter I - INTRODUCTION
1.
Acoustic Emission (AE) testing is a powerful method for examining the behavior of materials deforming
under stress. Acoustic Emission may be defined as a transient elastic wave generated by the rapid release of
energy within a material. Materials "talk" when they are in trouble: with Acoustic Emission equipment you
can "listen" to the sounds of cracks growing, fibers breaking and many other modes of active damage in the
stressed material. Small-scale damage is detectable long before failure, so AE can be used as a nondestructive technique to find defects during structural proof tests and plant operation. AE also offers unique
capabilities for materials research and development in the laboratory. Finally, AE equipment is adaptable to
many forms of production QC testing, including weld monitoring and leak detection.
Some typical applications of the Acoustic Emission principle in testing materials are as follows:
Behavior of materials: metals, ceramics, composites, rocks, concrete:
Crack propagation
Yielding
Fatigue
Corrosion, Stress corrosion
Creep
Fiber fracture, delamination
Material processing
Phase transformation in metals and alloys (martensitic transformation)
Detection of defects such as pores, quenching cracks, inclusions, etc.
Fabrication
Deforming processes rolling, forging, extruding
Welding and brazing detects detection (inclusions, cracks, lack of penetration)
TIG, MIG, spot, electron beam, etc.
Weld monitoring for process control
Monitoring structures:
Special applications:
Petrochemical and chemical: storage tanks, reactor vessels, offshore platforms, drill pipe, pipelines,
valves, hydro-treaters
Electric utilities: nuclear reactor vessels, piping, steam generators, ceramic insulators, transformers,
aerial devices
Aircraft and aerospace: fatigue cracks, corrosion, composite structures, etc.
Electronics: loose particles in electronic components, bonding, substrate cracking.
Copyright 2005, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Junction, New Jersey, USA
-1-
2.
Rev. 2
Chapter I Introduction
Copyright 2005, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Junction, New Jersey, USA
-2-
Rev. 2
Chapter I Introduction
purchased instead of 2 or more. One final advantage over the previous SPARTAN and DiSP instruments is that
the SAMOS can be purchased with waveform acquisition as standard, no extra cost, processing and display
capability on every channel to enhance its versatility and AE analysis performance.
In addition to these standard rugged SAMOS AE system enclosures, a -SAMOS chassis for use with up to 3
PCI-8 boards (24 channels) is available. This subsystem, no bigger than a notebook computer, is capable of
being operated from a notebook computer (see figure 4). This is exciting because now it is possible to operate
both the notebook computer and the -SAMOS chassis on battery power to make them completely portable
(battery operation is optional on the -DiSP). In addition to being portable and with up to 24 channels in one
small system, the performance of the system is very close to that of the PCI based system enclosures. The
reason for that is due to the PC-Card interface that plugs into the notebook computer and interfaces with the SAMOS chassis. This is a 32 bit Card-bus which parallels the PCI-bus specification.
Copyright 2005, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Junction, New Jersey, USA
-3-
2.1
Rev. 2
Chapter I Introduction
A single board CPU (shown at the top right of the figure) provides all the standard resources needed by the PC
computer including RAM, hard and floppy disk, RW-CD , the video output, keyboard and mouse inputs, serial
COM, USB and parallel ports. In addition, the CPU board provides a high speed PCI bus path for additional
cards. All chassiss have a CPU board even if they will be part of a multiple chassis system. It is desirable to
utilize this smart chassis concept in each PCI-8, with a standard high speed communications interface for
several good reasons.
Smart expansion chassiss can be used either as multiple smaller systems or as part of a larger AE
system.
Smart expansion chassiss allow the performance of the entire AE system to be scalable. Hit rate
performance will increase with the number of chassis. In a single CPU system with multiple dumb
chassis, the hit rate does not change with the number of chassis or expansions.
Adding a network interface is more reliable then extending the actual bus signals. A network is lower
cost and more proven as a high speed transfer medium.
Copyright 2005, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Junction, New Jersey, USA
-4-
Rev. 2
Chapter I Introduction
Adding a server computer can improve performance even more since the AE clients can be
concentrating on data collection and not have to worry about display, event detection, location or
other high-end data processing.
Some of the cards that are in the system include multiple PCI-8 cards (shown on the left side of the figure), a
100 BaseT network card (this might be part of the CPU board or a standalone card and is optional), a multichannel Audio board and an Expansion Interface board (optional).
The SAMOS AE system and the PAC developed and manufactured PCI-8 cards take advantage of the latest PC
bus standard, the PCI bus. Through the high performance PCI (Peripheral Component Interconnect) bus,
significant AE data transfer speeds (up to 132 MegaBytes/second), can be attained, assuring a wide
bandwidth bus for multi-channel AE data acquisition and optional waveform processing. The 32 bit PCI
bus has become the de-facto standard in all PC computers being shipped today.
The SAMOS AE system is truly a new advanced development that will revolutionize your acoustic
emission application. The heart of the system is the new PCI-8 card. This single board AE system is
described more fully in the next section.
Copyright 2005, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Junction, New Jersey, USA
-5-
2.2
Rev. 2
Chapter I Introduction
The Physical Acoustics, SAMOS AE System on a Board (see figure 6) is an 8 channel, Digital Signal
Processing (DSP) based, cost effective, AE data acquisition system on a single full-size PCI card. Through
the high performance PCI (Peripheral Component Interconnect) bus and Direct Memory Access (DMA)
architecture, significant AE data transfer speeds (up to 132 MegaBytes/second), can be attained, assuring a
wide bandwidth bus for multi-channel AE data acquisition and waveform transfer. The 32 bit PCI bus is
the de-facto standard in all PC computers being shipped today. Therefore, PCI-8 AE Subsystem boards can
be implemented inside most standard PC computers or inside one of PACs four (4), rugged, multichannel
PAC system chassiss. Due to advances in surface mount technology and high density ASIC (high density
Programmable Gate Arrays) devices, PAC has been able to provide this single AE System on a Board with
8 complete high speed, AE channels of real time AE data acquisition, with real time feature extraction,
waveform processing and transfer, 2 analog parametric input channels and 8 digital input and output
control signals all on a single board with no plug in modules.
8 complete, AE channe1s with waveform and hit processing built-in, on one full size PCI card.
16 bit, 1MHz A/D converter on each channel provides wide dynamic range without the need for
gain changes.
4 High Pass and 4 Low Pass filter selections for each channel, totally under software control.
Up to 2 parametrics on each PCI-8 board with 16 bit A/D converter and update rates up to 10,000
readings/second (when attached to hit data). The first parametric provides signal conditioning
including gain control and filtering options.
PCI AE data transfer rates of up to 132 Mbytes/sec to PC computer. Designed with multiple
FPGAs and ASIC ICs, to provide extreme high performance and minimize components and cost.
Hit LED drivers are built within the PCI-8 board so that LEDs can be attached directly.
Built-in AE feature extraction provides high speed transient data analysis at high hit rates.
Built in waveform processing with DMA & Bus Mastering transfer for high speed transfer of
waveforms on all 8 AE channels needed for AE.
Digital signal processing circuitry virtually eliminates drift, thereby achieving high accuracy and
reliability.
Copyright 2005, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Junction, New Jersey, USA
-6-
2.3
Rev. 2
Chapter I Introduction
A simplified block diagram of the PCI-8 board is shown in figure 7. The input signal directly from the PAC
preamplifiers (or the PAC integral preamplifier sensors) are routed to each of the PCI-8 channel inputs. These
are SMB connectors located on the rear PC metal hold-down bracket of the board. Phantom power for
powering the preamps is available on the center conductor of the AE input coaxial connector as is PACs
standard unique AST (automated sensor test) which provides computer controlled pulsing of each active AE
channel for determination of sensor coupling efficiency and system verification. Also featured on the
preamplifier power supply is a D/A converter (DAC) preamplifier power voltage control. This voltage controls
a special 1222LF preamp which has built in voltage controlled gain and test signal. Therefore by varying the
DAC, the preamplifier can be software controlled to change its gain or conduct a self test.
The incoming AE signal is then conditioned and passed to the selectable filter circuitry where one of 4 High
Pass filters and one of 4 Low Pass filters is applied in accordance with the user programmed filter strategy. The
filtered signal then is passed to the 16 bit A/D converter module where the AE signal is digitized at rates up to
1.0 MS/sec. The 16 bit, digital AE output is then passed to the feature extraction circuitry (which converts the
signal into AE hits and features instantaneously). The high speed feature extracted data is transferred to the
computer for further processing through the PCI bus. Also, waveforms are processed and transferred to the
computer using high speed DMA access directly to the computer for collection, further processing and storage.
Copyright 2005, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Junction, New Jersey, USA
-7-
3.
Rev. 2
Chapter I Introduction
With AE products and now with the new PCI-8 product comes some commonly used terms relating to the
system and its parts. This section introduces and defines these terms.
AE (Acoustic Emission): AE is used for the abbreviation of Acoustic Emission throughout this manual
and the non-destructive test industry.
AEDSP-32/16: Also known as the AEDSP board or card, this is the PAC printed circuit board which is
the heart of the MISTRAS-2001 AE system. It has two complete digital data acquisition channels and an
on board Floating Point Digital Signal Processor.
ADTI: This acronym means, Aerial Device Testing Instrument. This describes the turn-key test that
is performed using the AIMS and DiSP instrument to inspect bucket trucks.
AIMS: This name (Acoustic emission Industrial Multichannel System) describes a PAC Acoustic
Emission Knowledge Based instrument with 16 56 AE channels that has been used in performing
standard Turn-key procedure based inspections (such as Bucket Truck Testing with the ADTI version
and Rail Road Tank Cars with the Transportation Instrument version AIMS system).
Digital AIMS: This is the name for the PAC AE product based on integrating one or more PCI-DSP4
cards into a rugged industrial rated computer and chassis to carry out turn-key procedure based
inspections.
DiSP: This is the name for the PAC AE product based on integrating one or more PCI-DSP cards into a
computer or PAC multichannel chassis. DiSP can be thought of as a Digital SPARTAN or you can think
of the very advanced DSP architecture built within the DiSP.
DSP: This terminology describes the Digital Signal Processor that resides on the PCI-DSP card. A
second DSP processor resides in each waveform option board as well. A DSP is a special purpose
microprocessor that is specifically made for high speed processing, data manipulation and mathematics
relating to the processing of digital signals.
Command Line: The command line refers to an executable's (.EXE or .COM) program name and any
special commands (usually referred to as switches or options) that follow the program name which alter
the operation of that program. As an example calling the program; MOUSE.COM /1 /L then
<ENTER> would execute the mouse program on COM port (Serial Port) #1 and be configured for a lefthanded person. In this case the command line is all the items in Bold.
DTA or Data File: A data file refers to the files generated and stored on your hard disk by the PAC
programs used with the AE system when carrying out a test. All PAC data files use the .DTA extension
(e.g. TEST0000.DTA) and can easily be recognized in file directories by looking for that file extension
name.
GUI: This term stands for Graphical User Interface. This is the stand industry term given to software
which supports a mouse and has "graphical" windowed pull-down menus. The most familiar programs
that use a GUI is Microsoft's WINDOWS.
INI or Initialization File: An initialization file saves complete AE system configuration information,
including data acquisition H/W setup, graph setup, location set-up, filter set-up, etc. that can be recalled
into your AE system at any time to restore it to a set-up that you desire to run. All PAC initialization
files use the .INI file name extension (e.g., MI-LOC.INI) and can easily be recognized in file directories
by looking for that file extension name.
Copyright 2005, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Junction, New Jersey, USA
-8-
Rev. 2
Chapter I Introduction
ISA Bus: This is the standard bus used in most PC compatible computers to plug in computer expansion
cards. The term ISA means "Industry Standard Architecture." The bus is a 16 bit bus and can be
recognized immediately by noting the two card edge connectors (one 62 pin and one 36 pin) at the
bottom of the board that make up the ISA bus.
Layout file: A layout file is the nomenclature used in AEwin software, to donate the stored software
setup or initialization file. All AEwin initialization (or Layout) files use the file extension LAY to
distinguish them as a setup file.
Menu: A menu as used in this manual refers to the choices that are made on the computer screen when
setting up and running the software programs supplied. These menus can be pull-down menus or just a
list of functions presented on the screen.
MISTRAS-2001: MISTRAS-2001 is the name of the entire AE system including AEDSP-32/16
board(s), PAC Olive, expansion chassis (if used), sensors, preamplifiers, cables and operation software.
Sometimes the word MISTRAS is used in its place.
MISTRAS: MISTRAS has two meanings depending on the context within which it is used. Generally,
MISTRAS is used interchangeably with MISTRAS-2001. However the standard software supplied with
the MISTRAS-2001 is also called MISTRAS. This software performs independent channel data
acquisition along with Linear Location. It is similar to the DAQ software that we supply with other
products such as SA -DAQ or LO-DAQ, etc. Therefore when used in the software context, MISTRAS
denotes the program MISTRAS.EXE.
PAC: This is the abbreviation for Physical Acoustics Corporation, the company which is proud to
provide you with the SAMOS AE system and support you in your non-destructive testing work.
PCI: The high performance PCI (Peripheral Component Interconnect) bus, is a high speed PC
computer bus available in most of todays PC computers. It offers 32 bit wide data paths and up to
132 MegaBytes/second data transfer speeds. The 32 bit PCI bus has become the de-facto standard in
all PC computers being shipped today.
PCI-8: The PCI-8 is a PCI based AE data acquisition, AE System on a board with 8 full and complete
AE real time, feature extraction and waveform processing channels.
Olive or PC Olive : The PAC Olive is the IBM PC compatible computer that PAC markets and sells for
use with its PC compatible products. PAC Olive is the computers company name and designation.
Root (or Root Directory): This corresponds to that section of your hard disk (usually C:\>) which has
the boot up information which the computer needs to initialize. All other directories and sub-directories
are called from that root directory.
SAMOS: SAMOS is the name given to AE systems delivered from Physical Acoustics Corporation
incorporating the PCI-8, 8 channel, AE systems on a board hardware.
TSR (Terminate and Stay Resident): This is a PC computer program jargon for a software program that
is loaded into memory and stays inactive in the background of the main program which is running until
some special keys are pressed at which time it initiates and carries out its function. As an example
GRAFPLUS is a TSR which is always in memory and ready to print the screen upon pressing the <ShiftPrint-Screen> keys at which point it will print out the screen on the printer.
Copyright 2005, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Junction, New Jersey, USA
-9-
3.1.1
Rev. 2
Chapter I Introduction
The glossary is presented in two forms, First, selected key terms are shown in a logical order that shows
how standard terminology is used to describe the AE process from source to data storage. Second, a more
complete glossary is presented in alphabetical order. Definitions for items marked with an asterisk are
drawn from ASTM E 1316, sometimes with minor changes.
3.1.1.1
Elastic waves generated by the rapid release of energy from sources within a
material.
Event (AE)
Source
Sensor
Signal
The electrical signal coming from the transducing element and passing through
the subsequent signal conditioning equipment (amplifiers, frequency filters).
Channel
Detection
Hit
Signal Features
The set of numbers representing signal features and other information, stored as
a result of a hit.
The set of numbers used to describe an event, pursuant to data processing that
recognizes that a single event can produce more than one hit.
3.1.1.2
Elastic waves generated by the rapid release of energy from sources within a
material.
Activation (AE)
The onset of AE due to the application of a stimulus such as force, pressure, heat
etc.
Activity* (AE)
Copyright 2005, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Junction, New Jersey, USA
- 10 -
Rev. 2
Chapter I Introduction
Amplitude (AE)
Amplitude Distribution*
Attenuation
Loss of amplitude with distance as the wave travels through the test structure.
Burst emission*
Channel (AE)
Continuous emission*
Counts
The number of times the AE signal crosses the detection threshold. Also known
as "ringdown counts", "threshold crossing counts".
dBae
Detection (AE)
Event* (AE)
The set of numbers used to describe an event, pursuant to data processing that
recognizes that a single event can produce more than one hit.
Event Description
The total elastic energy (in the wave) released by an acoustic emission event.
Felicity Effect*
(The reverse of the Kaiser effect) The presence of AE at stress levels below the
maximum previously experienced..
Frequency
For an oscillating signal or process, the number of cycles occurring in unit time.
Guard Sensors
Hit (AE)
The set of numbers representing signal features and other information, stored as a
result of a hit.
Intensity* (AE)
A measure of the size of the emission signals detected, such as the average
amplitude, average AE energy or average counts.
Copyright 2005, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Junction, New Jersey, USA
- 11 -
Rev. 2
Chapter I Introduction
Kaiser Effect*
kHz
Location*
Relating to the use of multiple AE Sensors for determining the relative positions
of acoustic emission sources.
Noise
Nondestructive
Testing(NDT)*
that do not impair future usefulness and serviceability in order to detect, locate,
measure and evaluate flaws; to assess integrity, properties and composition; and
to measure geometrical characteristics.
Parametric Inputs
Risetime
Sensor
(AE)
A device containing a transducing element that turns AE wave motion
into an electrical voltage.
Signal (AE)
The electrical signal coming from the transducing element and passing through
the subsequent signal conditioning equipment (amplifiers, frequency filters).
Signal Description
Signal Features
Source (AE)
The total energy (of all forms) dissipated by the source process.
(Primary) Zone
The area surrounding a sensor from which AE can be detected and from which
AE will strike the sensor before striking any other sensors.
Copyright 2005, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Junction, New Jersey, USA
- 12 -
4.
Rev. 2
Chapter I Introduction
AVAILABLE CONFIGURATIONS
4.1
A SAMOS system is an AE System based on using one or more PCI-8, 8 channel AE cards. A SAMOS
system can be configured in one of several ways:
A standard PC desktop computer can be configured with one or more PCI-8 cards (which can usually be
configured for up to 16 channels),
-SAMOS based, using the -SAMOS chassis with a notebook computer, one two or three PCI-8 cards
(for 24 AE channels) or,
Use of PACs more rugged and industrial chassiss. These chassis have been designed with appropriate
industrial ruggedness, flow-through card cooling, AE Hit LEDs and AE Audio output compatibility for
AE monitoring using sound feedback. (Audio output is standard on the Portable and Large Multichannel
units and optional on the Benchtop series).
PAC has three different chassis that can offer up to 112 channels of AE operation. These include;
1.
the SAMOS-32, a low cost Benchtop series that can handle up to 4 boards (or 32 channels),
2.
the SAMOS 48, rugged, field portable chassis, with up to 6 PCI-8 boards (for up to 48 channels),
3.
The SAMOS-64, large multichannel chassis, capable of handling up to 8 or more PCI-8 boards
(theoretically up to 14 boards for 112 channels), in a single system enclosure.
4.
The standard SAMOS AE System includes the following internal and external hardware components.
4.2
PAC System Chassis with internal PC computer (-SAMOS uses an external notebook
computer)
High resolution Super VGA Monitor, Keyboard, Mouse
PCI-8 Cards (8 channels per board)
PAC Audio Monitor board (standard in Portable and Large Multichannel systems, optional in
all others including PAC Olive, -SAMOS and SAMOS-32, Benchtop series).
AE Integral Preamplifier Sensors
Signal Cables between Preamps and PC
Power Cables
AEwin software and software options
Number of Channels
Each PCI-8 card processes 8 AE channels. All PCI-8 boards are the same. (Unlike the PCI/DSP-4, there is
no need for a first board in the system being a parametric based board). The reason for this is that each PCI-8
board has 2, 16 bit parametrics built-in as standard. The number of parametrics available in the AE system
then increases by 2 for each board in the system, up to 8 parametrics total. The typical PC computer can hold
2 PCI-8 cards or 16 AE channels. The standard Benchtop model chassis, SAMOS-32, offers a maximum of 4,
PCI-8 cards for 32 channels. The rugged, portable SAMOS-48 chassis holds 6, PCI-8 cards for a maximum
of 48 AE channels. The large, multichannel SAMOS-64 chassis holds up to 14, PCI-8 cards for a maximum
of 112 channels and the SAMOS-NEMA outdoor multi-channel system which can hold up to 4, PCI-8 cards
for a maximum of 32 channels. Each chassis holds the PC computer in addition to the PCI-8 cards, making
the system a full AE system with integral computer.
Copyright 2005, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Junction, New Jersey, USA
- 13 -
Rev. 2
Chapter I Introduction
The -SAMOS chassis holds a maximum of 3 PCI-8 cards for a maximum of 24 channels, notebook controlled
AE system.
4.3
The computer used inside these SAMOS system chassiss, is a fully PC compatible computer. Due to the ever
changing PC specifications and the fact that continuous improvements are being made and prices changing, the
following standard system is continuously subject to change. Please contact our sales department for current
computer specifications.
As a standard computer, PAC provides the user with all the features that are expected in an everyday computer.
Users have grown accustomed to the desktop computer and its standard and optional features. From that
standpoint, these features are built within each SAMOS AE system. As a minimum, a user can expect the
following PC hardware in the SAMOS AE system.
STANDARD COMPUTER FEATURES
OPTIONS
4.4
Each channel requires its own sensor, preamplifier and connecting cables With very few exceptions,
all PAC manufactured sensors and preamplifiers are mutually interchangeable. Some sensors have integral
cables for connection to the preamplifier but most require a separate cable. Integral-preamplifier sensors have
their preamplifier built into the sensor case. The length of the cable between the preamplifier and the SAMOS
AE system may be selected to suit the needs of the application environment. This can be from several feet to
over thousands of feet (PAC 1224 series of line drivers might be required for lengths greater than 2000 feet).
The SAMOS AE systems come with standard Auto-Sensor Test (AST) capability built-in, which provides an
automated method of testing 1 or multiple sensors in a system under system software control. Select integral
sensors and PAC preamplifiers with integral AST option to take advantage of this tremendous capability.
Copyright 2005, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Junction, New Jersey, USA
- 14 -
Rev. 2
Chapter I Introduction
Sensors:
PAC manufactures a wide range of sensors. Remember the 1 kHz 400 kHz bandwidth
limitation of the SAMOS AE systems when selecting sensors. Some PAC sensors have
integrated preamplifiers, reducing cabling and simplifying setup; these are the R6I, R15I type
models. With the built-in "Auto Sensor Test" capability on the PCI-8, make sure you use
sensors with the built-in AST as they can be used for automated pulsing and receiving and
sensor coupling/sensitivity checks. Other popular sensors, used with external preamplifiers
such as the separate 0/2/4, 2/4/6, In-Line series (single and differential models) and 1220AAST preamplifiers, are the A3, R6 and R15 sensors. It is recommended to utilize the AST
version preamplifiers with the PCI-8 to automate sensor testing.
Preamp:
For passive sensors such as the A3, R6, and R15, etc., PAC has various models of
Preamplifiers with built in AST (auto sensor test). These include the 0/2/4, 2/4/6, In-Line
Differential, In-Line Single ended preamplifiers. These models have been designed to
condition sensor outputs to be acceptable for inputs on all PAC instruments. They each have
AST (auto-sensor test) capability of self pulsing the sensor for test of a single sensor or groups
of sensors on the same structure.
Cables:
The 1234-XX cable is the standard coaxial RG-58/AU cables used between PAC Integral
preamplifier sensors (such as the R6I and the R15I). They are standard RG-58 50 Ohm
coaxial cables to be used when connecting between the preamp outputs and the input of the
AE System. PAC manufactures these in varying lengths for any application. The special
(RED) sensor cables (#1230 and #1232) have been designed to optimize noise rejection of
piezoelectric devices. These connect between sensors and preamps.
7030-4009
The PCI-8 uses an SMB connector. To attach a cable to this connector, there must be a
matching plug on the cable. This cable assembly is a 1 ft. (30 cm) SMB connector to BNC
Receptacle Adapter cable, which allows for connecting directly to standard PAC 1234 cables.
These are available (as an option) for sale with your SAMOS system or PCI-8 boards.
Frequency Filtering
The system provides frequency filtering both in the preamplifiers and on the PCI-8 board The 1220A
and 2/4/6 preamplifiers use a plug-in filter module with a specified type and frequency value. This filter can
be "high pass," "low pass" or "bandpass." The most standard selection is a narrow bandwidth, "bandpass"
filter. However, with the multiple selection filter capability built within the PCI-8 cards, it is recommended
that a wide bandwidth filter (1 kHz 400 kHz) is used and that the actual filter selection is made within the
SAMOS AE system, under software control. This allows flexibility in selecting sensors and frequency ranges
for the final application without requiring any internal hardware or manual filter changes. It is therefore
recommended that the preamplifier use a wide bandwidth filter such as a PAC 2-14-40 1-200BP or 2-1440 200LP, unless the application is settled and requires something specific, which may be selected from
PAC's standard list or custom built to your needs. Other preamplifiers such as PACs in-line series have
internal fixed filters and need to be ordered with a specific frequency and gain.
In addition in the PCI-8, a bank of high performance, active filters are built within each channel on the PCI-8
card. Each channel contains 4 High Pass filters, meaning that they pass frequencies above the stated
cutoff frequency, and 4 Low Pass filters, meaning that they pass frequencies below the stated cutoff
frequency. These filters are software selectable by the AEwin software. Having 4 high pass and 4 low pass
filters, each being independently selected provides many useful AE system bandwidths. The standard Filter
values for the PCI-8 card are as follows:
High Pass Filters
HP-1
1 kHz
HP-2
5 kHz
Copyright 2005, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Junction, New Jersey, USA
- 15 -
Rev. 2
HP-3 20 kHz
HP-4 100 kHz
Chapter I Introduction
LP-3
LP-4
100 kHz
400 kHz
As an example, to make a 100200 kHz BandPass filter, the user would select the HP-4 and LP-4 selections.
The AEwin acquisition software has a menu to aid in this frequency selection. Refer to the AEwin software
users manual for more information on the setup menus.
4.5.1 Using a Filters.set File
On systems that have non-standard filters there exists a special file Filters.set. The purpose of this file
is to make sure that the text AEwin displays in the hardware setup dialog reflects the choices available for
that channel. Systems built at the factory with non-standard filters, come with filters.set pre-configured.
The following is a detailed description of this file.
When to use this file:
a) If you have non-standard filters on any data acquisition channels.
b) If you have non-standard filters and want the correct filter values shown in the hardware setup menu
when you are in 'replay-only' mode.
Please understand that creating a filters.set file with frequencies that are not available in the AE channel
will not make that frequency available. The purpose of this file is only to make sure that the text AEwin
displays in the hardware setup dialog reflects the choices available for that channel.
When AEwin initializes it looks for a file named filters.set in the program folder of the computer. If it
finds one it will load it, overriding the default filter values for all channels listed in the file.
FILE FORMAT AND DESCRIPTION:
If a semicolon ';' is the first character of a line, the line will be ignored when it is read by the program.
Semicolons are for putting comments and notes into the file. Semicolons do not work as 'to end of line'
comments, they can only be the first character of a line to function as a comment. Blank lines are also
ignored and are ok to have in the file.
The following fields are required to define a filter. All fields must present and in the correct order (as
described).
FIELD
DESCRIPTION
filter:
The number of the filter, first filter is '2', add '1' for each defined filter (if a second filter is
defined set this number to '3', a third would be '4' etc.)
highpass:
The value for each of the available highpass filters, in kHz, for the channels that are
defined. These values are always listed in increasing order.
lowpass:
The value for each of the available lowpass filters, in kHz, for the channels that are
defined. With the exception of the first value, which is the largest value, these are listed
in increasing order.
channel:
A list of channels that use the defined filter. If there are many channels using the same
filter, multiple channel lines are permitted (each line must start with channel:). Also, if all
channels in the system have the same filter configuration, specifying 0 for the channel sets
all channels to the defined filter.
Acceptable delimiters for all fields are spaces and tabs, do not use commas or any other characters to
separate fields or field entries. e.g. channel:...1,2,3,4 is not acceptable (. and , are not valid).
Copyright 2005, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Junction, New Jersey, USA
- 16 -
Rev. 2
Chapter I Introduction
After you create a filters.set file (using notepad or some other pure text editor, NOT Word or Excel), you
should check the AEwin hardware setup dialog and make sure that the entries for the analog filters are
correct.
TYPICAL AVAILABLE FILTERS:
The following define the standard filters that are available for the PCI-8
highpass: 10 20 100 200
lowpass: 400 10 40 100
EXAMPLE:
The actual filters.set file should be placed in the program folder of the AEwin program (same folder as
AEwin.exe).
Cut the following text and put it into a file named filters.set (which may already exist). Note that it is not
necessary to do this as the following example uses the default filter values. If you received a board with custom
filters, you need to modify the values as described above.
| -------------- CUT BELOW THIS LINE ---------------|
filter: 2
highpass: 10 20 100 200
lowpass: 400 10 40 100
channel: 0
| -------------- CUT ABOVE THIS LINE ---------------|
4.6
All software provided with the SAMOS AE system whether standard or optional is installed onto the
computer's hard disk and ready to run immediately upon booting the SAMOS AE system. In addition, a spare
copy of the software is provided on diskette or CD for backup purposes. Software provided with the standard
PCI-8 System comprises:
A.
WINDOWS : This is loaded onto the system and prepared to run. The Windows CD and certificate and
any associated documentation is also provided.
B.
Driver S/W:
Driver software (usually on CD) and a users manual for the associated computer is also
provided.
C.
AEwin:
AEwin for SAMOS is the WINDOWS based, AE acquisition, analysis and replay
software program provided with the SAMOS And PCI-8 based systems. This extremely
powerful Acoustic Emission program uses all of WINDOWS resources, providing users
with a very familiar Windows interface while at the same time performing AE data
acquisition, analysis and replay. Also included is waveform processing and display,
multiple graphs per screen, and zonal and linear location modes as standard. Further
information about the AEwin software is provided in the AEwin software users manual
(chapter 4).
4.7
Optional Software
Optional software for the SAMOS AE systems is broken down into two different categories. First, are those
options which are available within the AEwin program. These options extend the capability of AEwin. The
Copyright 2005, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Junction, New Jersey, USA
- 17 -
Rev. 2
Chapter I Introduction
second category are those separate programs which provide additional functions outside of AEwin. (consult
PAC for availability) includes:
4.7.1
AEwin Options
2D-LOC:
Full Planar, 2 Dimensional Location Option: The two-dimensional (2D) source location
option adds a versatile planar location capability into the AEwin standard location setup.
The advanced 2D Planar Smart Location Algorithm (SLA) can handle sensors in any
position and provides accurate location information. This is regardless of whether the
sensors are arranged in a rectangular, triangular, or haphazard manner. An easy setup
screen allows a mouse oriented, automated or manual sensor placement and a grid type
(spreadsheet) editing table. The user is also able to enter and visualize the type of
structure being setup (plate, pipe, vessel, etc.). The software will take advantage of the
geometry to aid in setup, sensor placement, and even in performing the location
algorithm. The location algorithm takes advantage of the geometry and also uses
information from each of the sensors, which have detected the event. Using the
integrated attenuation analysis, the user can also visualize the detection range of a given
size source event. Also, the location provides information on the actual source
amplitude. The built-in Clustering capability allows multiple clusters graphs and groups,
colorized cluster severity levels and zoom and history plots on a selected cluster. A
section of this manual is devoted to AEwin software.
3D-LOC:
Three dimensional location (3D-LOC) software adds the 3D-Location option to the
existing Location setup menus. The 3D-LOC setup screen allows a mouse oriented
sensor placement capability, and table editing features for accurate 3D sensor
placement. The 3D-Location algorithm also incorporates a Smart Location
Algorithm to take advantage of the geometry of sensor placement as well as data from
all the sensors that detected the event (up to 8), in calculating an accurate source. A
minimum of 4 hits in an event is needed to determine and display a 3D location. The
source location plot shows the event on a 3-dimensional screen which is easily and
fully rotatable, can be zoomed and panned and seen at any orientation in acquisition
and replay. Clustering is also provide to show and assess groups of AE events.
SPHERE-LOC
TB-LOCwin:
Tank Bottom Location allows the user to easily setup and perform tank bottom location
determination. A Tank Bottom menu item is added to the Location setup with this
option allowing the user to set up for a Tank Bottom test by sizing and creating the
tank bottom graphic, automatically placing the sensors, and carrying out a Tank
Bottom location with tank display.
AEwinPOST:
AEwin Post is a fully featured utility in AEwin for post processing Acoustic Emission
data. The utility allows data preview using graphs, plots and tabular views. The data
can be sorted and filtered through user selected actions or user defined advanced filters.
Copyright 2005, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Junction, New Jersey, USA
- 18 -
Rev. 2
Chapter I Introduction
Waveform viewing and feature extraction, first hit extraction and many more
operations. The treated data can be exported to a new DTA or TDA file for use with
AEwin.
32 Groups :
8 Location groups are standard in AEwin. This option expands the limit to 32
independent location groups. This is very useful in cases where many similar
structures are being tested at the same time.
AEwin Replay:
This low cost option allows you to purchase a copy of AEwin for use on a separate
analysis computer.
Those optional software packages that can be purchased to complement your SAMOS AE System include
the following:
NOESIS:
Noesis is an advanced pattern analysis and recognition software for use both with AE
features and waveform data. This software includes Supervised and non-supervised,
statistical and neural network based pattern recognition analysis and classification, data
clustering and data visualization in 2 and 3 dimensional graphs. Noesis also allows for
advanced post test manipulation, filtering and data visualization capabilities.
PolyModal Software: PolyModal Wave Toolbox software is a WINDOWS based, waveform software post
analysis package that combines classical wave mode analysis and digital signal
processing methods with AE applications and test data. The software allows the user to
analyze waveform data files and perform multiple filtering steps, digital signal
processing, event detection, feature extraction and location determination strategies.
Integrated within PolyModal is a materials database and geometry based dispersion
curves which allow the user to select filtering and digital processing strategies based on
wave modes and their characteristics for the specific material, thickness and boundary
conditions. Additional and optional add-on packages include AE Wavelet analysis, Short
time FFTs and Acousto-Ultrasonic analysis.
Wavelet & Short Time FFT Analysis Software: This program is a post processing waveform based
WINDOWS program for visualization and processing of waveforms in the
Time/Frequency domain.
Internet & Remote Control Software: PAC Systems have options that allow them to be connected to the
users network, or the internet, and control or monitor a test from a remote computer.
This software is built right into our main AE software packages as an option and is user
friendly. Many times the user performs analysis at his remote computer as if he is
working directly on the AE system and can start and stop a test, download data files and
view live reports and graphs.
Copyright 2005, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Junction, New Jersey, USA
- 19 -
5.
Rev. 2
Chapter I Introduction
SPECIFICATIONS
The following specifications are broken down into two main categories. The first section (section 5.1)
describes specifications associated with the entire SAMOS AE system, composed of the AE system chassis,
internal computer and PCI-8 cards. The second section (section 5.2) describes the PCI-8 card in detail.
Naturally, all specifications are subject to change. If there is doubt about a specification, please contact the
Physical Acoustics Customer Service department.
5.1
Operating Environment:
Temperature:
Humidity:
Altitude:
Shock:
Vibration:
Internal Computer:
PC Bus:
CPU:
Memory:
Hard Disk:
Floppy:
CD ROM Drive:
Video:
Serial:
Parallel/Printer:
USB
Network Option:
10 - 45 C
8 90% Relative Humidity, non-condensing
10,000 feet pressure altitude
10g, 3 axis
1.5g, 3 axis
Copyright 2005, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Junction, New Jersey, USA
- 20 -
5.2
Rev. 2
Chapter I Introduction
Electrical Specifications
AE Inputs:
Input Impedance:
Preamplifier Power:
Sensor Testing:
Frequency Response:
8 channels
50
DAC Controlled preamplifier power (which can be
used for gain control if used with the appropriate
preamplifier, e.g. 1222LF).
AST built-in
1 kHz - 400 kHz (at 3 dB points)
Signal Processing
AE Signal Gain
0, 6 dB computer selectable
Filters
4 High Pass Computer selectable filters1 kHz, 5.0 kHz, 20 kHz, 100 kHz, 4th order
Butterworth
4 Low Pass Computer selectable filters
10 kHz, 40 kHz, 100 kHz, 400 kHz, 4th order
Butterworth
ASL:
100 dB AE
ASL99 dB
ADC Type
Dynamic Range:
Sample Rate:
Copyright 2005, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Junction, New Jersey, USA
- 21 -
Extracted AE Features:
Rev. 2
Chapter I Introduction
Analog Parametrics;
Number of Parametric Channels:
Parametric A/D Resolution:
Parametric Sample Rate:
Time Driven Data Rate;
Time Parametrics:
2 Channels
16 bits
10 kHz sample rate for each analog parametric.
Controlled by software. 10 msec. to 60 seconds.
All parametrics are available in time data set.
Parametric #1 functions:
Parametric #2 functions:
Digital I/O:
Copyright 2005, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Junction, New Jersey, USA
- 22 -
5.3
Rev. 2
Chapter I Introduction
A board component and connector layout of the PCI-8 card is shown in figure 8, along with its PC metal
bracket connections as seen outside the AE system chassis. Also shown on the layout are all the internal
connectors including J4, J5, J6 and J8.
Due to space considerations of the PCI-8 PC metal bracket, only the eight AE input connectors are present.
These connectors are industry standard SMB connectors that stick out of the back of the system chassis.
These connectors accept input from the AE phantom power preamplifiers or integral preamplifier sensors.
Channel numbering sequence is shown in the figure and usually etched or imprinted on the metal bracket.
5.4
A board layout of connectors on the PCI-8 board is shown in figure 8. On the figure can be seen all the
connectors available on the PCI-8 card for interfacing. Below is a description of each of these connectors and
their use. Pin assignments for those connectors which are accessible by the user is also provided.
There are 4 main connectors on each PCI-8 card. These connectors are all located on the top of the board.
They include the J-5 Audio output connector, located on the top left of the board. Located on the right side of
the board on the top are the J-8, Real Time control bus connector that connects between each PCI-8 card in the
system, the J-6 Parametric input connector, and the J-8 Hit LED output connector. In addition, there is one
other connector labeled J1 located at the bottom of the board, near the center. This is the J1, JTAG port for
internal PAC testing use.
5.4.1
The J-5 Audio Connector provides Analog AE outputs for each AE channel on the board. The AE outputs
are meant to connect into PACs Audio board, which is available for all SAMOS AE System chassis. The
AE analog outputs can also be used for oscilloscope monitoring for test purposes. The Audio connector is a
3 pin connector. The pinout of the connector is listed on the table below. There is only one pin that
requires further discussion. This is pin 2. This pin is the combination or mixing of one or more of the onboard 8 channels as selected by the software Audio board control. The AEwin software is able to control
this switching function. It can output any combination of AE output channels onto this pin to the Audio
Copyright 2005, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Junction, New Jersey, USA
- 23 -
Rev. 2
Chapter I Introduction
board. All these controls are user selectable via the Audio board menu control in AEwin software. The
pinout of this connector is provided in the table below.
Pin #
Function
Description
Ground
Selected AE output
Ground
5.4.2
The J-8 Hit LED connector, provides outputs that can directly drive an external LED connected by the
customer. We have conditioned the AE hit signal to provide a time stretched digital output which is a
minimum of 50 milliseconds long or lasts for the entire hit duration, whichever is longer. We have also put this
time stretched signal through an LED driver and have internally connected the LED resistor so that the user can
easily just connect the LED anode to the appropriate pin of the connector and the cathode end to ground. The
Hit LED connector is a 10 pin IDC connector. The pinout of the 10 pin connector is shown in the table below.
Pin #
Name/Description
Specification
Hit LED #1
2
3
Hit LED #2
Hit LED #3
Hit LED #4
5
6
Hit LED #5
Hit LED #6
Hit LED #7
8
9
Hit LED #8
Digital Ground
10
Digital Ground
Digital Ground
5.4.3
The J-6 parametric connector is a 26 pin IDC connector. It has been designed to be connected via a ribbon
cable to the rear panel of the SAMOS AE system. The J-6 parametric contains 2 Parametric inputs (the first
being true differential), an programmable analog voltage output (for use as an excitation source for strain gage
bridges), 8 programmable digital inputs and 8 programmable digital outputs. The table below provides
complete information on the connector pin-out and description.
Copyright 2005, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Junction, New Jersey, USA
- 24 -
Pin #
Rev. 2
Function
Chapter I Introduction
Description
+ Parametric #1 Input
2
3
- Parametric #1 Input
Parametric #1 ground
Parametric #1 ground
5
6
Parametric #2 ground
Parametric #2 Input
8
9
0 10 volt DC output
10
No connection
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
Digital Input 7
Digital Input 8
19
20
21
Digital Output 3
22
Digital Output 4
23
24
Digital Output 5
Digital Output 6
25
Digital Output 7
26
Digital Output 8
5.4.4
The purpose of the J-4 Real time control connector is to control and coordinate each of the PCI-8 cards
from the first master card in the system. The connector is a 26 pin HD (high density) connector. This
connector performs multiple functions. It transmits the parametrics from the parametric control circuitry, it
coordinates the start and stopping of a test, it synchronizes the time of test clocks to the master one in the
first PCI-8 card, and coordinates other signals between the PCI-8 boards. A daisy chain ribbon connector
must be connected to each PCI-8 board in a multiple board system. The daisy chain connector must also
be connected to any repeater card when other AE system chassis will be used. Please make sure that this
connector is fastened securely to each PCI-8 card in the system and repeater card before running a test.
Since there are no user accessible connections, the pin-out is not specified.
Copyright 2005, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Junction, New Jersey, USA
- 25 -
5.5
Rev. 2
Chapter I Introduction
The PCI-8 board is a PCI (Peripheral Component Interface) board that is designed to be Plug-&-Play in a
typical PC computer with WINDOWS operating system software. Upon boot-up the PC computer scans all
the PCI boards in the system to determine their memory and usage requirements and automatically assigns a
working address in the computer. The PCI-8 being a PCI board operates very well with this standard and
traditional board addresses or hardware selections for things like interrupt selections and board addresses for
the PC bus are not required.
Since there can be multiple PCI-8 boards in the SAMOS AE System, there needs to be a way to identify
which channel group (in 8 channel increments) a given PCI-8 board should be assigned to. Specific AE
channels for multiple boards are set by SW-1, switches #16. SW-1 can be seen in figure 8 at the top right
hand side of the PCI-8 card. This addresses up to 64 boards for accessing up to 512 channels of AE. These
are set using a binary pattern where SW-1, position 1 corresponds to the LSB (least significant bit) and SW-1,
position 6 the MSB (most significant bit). It is programmed assuming that OFF or OPEN means a binary
weight of "1" and ON or CLOSED is a binary "0". Also it is programmed where all 0's (in the chart below)
correspond to board #1 (AE channels 1 - 8).
AE Board Addressing Examples:
Board #
#1
#2
#3
#4
#5
#6
#7
#8
.
.
.
#64
(On/Closed = 0, OFF/Open = 1)
Ch. #'s
1-8
9 - 16
17 - 24
25 32
33 - 40
41 - 48
49 - 56
57 - 64
505 - 512
1 1 1 1 1 1
When setting board addresses, please make sure that each board has a unique address and that boards are
assigned in a sequential order starting from board 1 and going up.
5.6
The PCI-8 board has 2 on-board PROMs that control the operation of the boards Field
Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGA s). From time to time, PAC offers PROM upgrades which
improve the performance of the PCI-8 boards. The PROMs are socketed on the board for easy field
replacement. Figure 8 shows the location and the IC number or U number of each PROM on the
PCI-8 board.
U9 is located in the center bottom of the PCI-8 card. This is the key FPGA PROM on the board. U6
is located just above the PCI bus, card edge connector. This PCI-PROM programs the initial state of
the PCI interface controller IC (which is U5), and just to the right of U6. These PROM ICs are easy
to spot because they are the only ICs in sockets. This also makes them easy to change.
Whenever you receive an upgrade package, you may receive one or more PROMs as part of the
upgrade. Just look on the label on the IC to note the associated U number to see where it goes.
Remove the existing part by gently prying between the PROM IC and its socket using a small, flat
bladed screwdriver. Install the new device by locating pin 1 on the PROM and pin 1 on the respective
socket. Position the PROM over the socket so that each pin of the PROM is aligned with its
Copyright 2005, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Junction, New Jersey, USA
- 26 -
Rev. 2
Chapter I Introduction
corresponding socket contact. Using gentle but firm thumb pressure to press the IC fully into the
socket. Inspect the IC after insertion for any bent pins or pins that may not be inserted into the socket.
5.7
The following is a list of all the board controllable AE features and timing controls on the board along with its
resolution and maximum range. Some of these features may or may not be accessible by some of the high
level software programs but are still in the board.
Signal Characteristics
Time of Hit/Time of Test
(PAC) Energy
Signal Strength
Absolute (True) Energy
Amplitude
Rise Time
Duration
Counts
Counts To Peak
Partial Power (w/waveform option)
Frequency Centroid
(w/waveform option)
Peak Frequency
(w/waveform option)
Initiation Frequency
(Rise Time based frequency)
Reverberation Frequency (Average
Frequency of AE burst after peak)
Average Frequency (Average
Frequency of entire AE burst)
RMS
ASL
Threshold
Resolution
Units
Range
0.250
1 count
1 count
1 count
1 dB
1 usec
1 usec
1 count
1 count
0.01%
1 kHz
Microseconds
10 volt-sec/count
3.05 picovolt-sec
9.31x10-22 Joules
1 dB
Microseconds
Microseconds
Count (Threshold crossing)
Counts
Percent of Total Power
KHz
0407 days
065,535
01.31x108 picovolt-sec
2.61x10-8 Joules
10100 dB
065.5 msec
01000 msec
065,535 counts
032,768 counts
0 100%
1 kHz 2100 kHz
1 kHz
KHz
1 kHz
KHz
0 65,535 kHz
1 kHz
KHz
0 65,535 kHz
1 kHz
KHz
0 65,535 kHz
0.15 millivolts
1 dB
1 dB
Millivolts
1 dB
1 dB
06 volts
0100 dB
1599 dB
Signal Characteristics
Resolution
Range
Analog Parametric #1
Analog Parametrics #2
Absolute Energy Rate
1 usec
1 usec
1 usec
40 usec65.5 msec
40 usec65.5 msec
40 usec65.5 msec
Copyright 2005, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Junction, New Jersey, USA
- 27 -
Rev. 2
Chapter I Introduction
Figure 9 shows the AEwin Data Sets menu. It is from this menu that AE Hit features and AE Time
Driven features are selected for processing and storage.
Referring to the figure 9, There is an area for selecting which AE Hit Features (left side of the menu) and
Time Driven AE Information. In regards to the hit features, note at the bottom of the menu, even up to 2
parametrics can be chosen to be in the hit data set. In this mode, parametric information can be updated at
rates up to 20,000 times per second. In addition, note that there are 14 standard AE features (top left side
of the menu).
5.7.1
Referring to the Hit based features, this section tries to provide a better definition as to what exactly each
feature means to the AE user. Figure 10 shows a fictitious Acoustic Emission waveform with some of the
AE features superimposed on the waveform.
Copyright 2005, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Junction, New Jersey, USA
- 28 -
Rev. 2
Chapter I Introduction
Following along with figure 10, the following features can be seen and described.
Time of Hi t:
(also known as Time of Test clock), This is the time at which a hit has been detected
by the PCI-8. This is detected the instant that the AE Signal exceeds the AE Threshold.
Amplitude:
Energy:
(also referred to as PAC-Energy). PAC Energy has been a PAC AE feature parameter
since 1978. PAC-Energy is a 2-byte parameter derived from the integral of the
rectified voltage signal over the duration of the AE hit (or waveform), hence the
voltage-time units). Although PAC-Energy has the same definition as Signal Strength
above, the only difference is in the sensitivity, size and dynamic range of this parameter.
In other PAC instruments, such as SPARTANs and LOCANs, the PAC Energy
feature is a gain dependent quantity. For example at 0 dB instrument gain, its resolution
Copyright 2005, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Junction, New Jersey, USA
- 29 -
Rev. 2
Chapter I Introduction
(also referred to as AE Threshold Crossing Counts). This AE Hit feature simply counts
the AE signal excursions over the AE Threshold. In figure 10, an example shows that 4
AE counts have been generated.
Duration:
AE Duration is defined as the time from the first threshold crossing to the end of the last
threshold crossing of the AE signal from the AE Threshold. An example is shown in
figure 8.
RMS:
Root Mean Square is a measure of the continuously varying AE signal voltage into the
AE system. RMS is an electrical engineering power term defined as the rectified, time
averaged AE signal, measured on a linear scale and reported in volts. In terms of an AE
hit feature, the instantaneous value of RMS voltage is collected and processed along with
the other AE Features when an AE hit is detected. Since there is an averaging required,
an RMS/ASL Time Constant Control is provided in the Data Sets menu to allow
adjustment between 10 1000 milliseconds (note the RMS/ASL Time Constant entry
box in the lower right side of the Data Sets menu of figure 8).
ASL:
Average Signal Level is a measure of the continuously varying and averaged amplitude
of the AE signal. This measurement is similar to that of RMS in that it is an averaged
reading. The main difference is that the RMS is following the Root Mean Square and is
measured in volts, whereas the ASL is following the Amplitude variation and is measured
in dB. Since there is an averaging required, an RMS/ASL Time Constant Control is
provided in the Data Sets menu to allow adjustment between 10 1000 milliseconds
(note the RMS/ASL Time Constant entry box in the lower right side of the Data Sets
menu of figure 8).
Threshold:
The Threshold Feature records the value of the Threshold at the time of an AE Hit. This
is only needed when an adaptive Threshold technique such as Floating Threshold is used,
as it is important to know the threshold value at the time of a hit.
Rise Time:
Rise Time is defined as the time between the AE Hit start and the peak amplitude of the
AE Hit. An example of the rise time measurement is shown in figure 9 for clarity.
Counts To Peak: Counts To Peak is a measure of the number of AE Counts between the AE Hit start and
the Peak Amplitude of the AE Hit. In regards to the example of figure 9, there are 3
Counts to Peak shown in that example.
Average Frequency:
Average Frequency has long been available in the PAC Hit data set. This
calculated feature, reported in kHz, determines an average frequency over the entire AE
hit. It is derived from other collected AE features, namely; AE Counts and Duration. All
these features must be enabled in the Data Sets dialog box for the Average Frequency
Copyright 2005, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Junction, New Jersey, USA
- 30 -
Rev. 2
Chapter I Introduction
Vs x 1__
1MHz
Copyright 2005, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Junction, New Jersey, USA
- 31 -
5.7.2
Rev. 2
Chapter I Introduction
The SAMOS AE system has the capability of calculating and processing frequency derived AE features in
real time. Up to 6 AE Frequency based features can be processed by SAMOS AE systems. Each of these
features requires that a real time FFT be performed on the received AE hit waveform. AE frequency
features include; Frequency Centroid, Peak Frequency, and 4 Partial Power frequency features. Each of
these are discussed below.
Frequency Centroid: Frequency Centroid (also known as the first moment of inertia) is a 2 byte value,
and reported in kHz. It is a real time Frequency derived feature. The Frequency Centroid
results from performing a real-time FFT and carrying out the following calculation on
each FFT element (or bin):
SUM(magnitude*frequency) / SUM(magnitude).
The SUM is performed over all FFT bins, excluding DC and is reported in kHz.
Peak frequency: The Peak frequency is a 2 byte value, reported in kHz, defined as the point in the Power
Spectrum at which the peak magnitude occurs. A real time FFT is performed on the
waveform associated with the AE hit. The frequency which contains the largest
magnitude is reported.
Each of these AE features, Centroid and Peak Frequency adds 2 bytes to the hit data message.
The resolution and range of the Centroid and Peak Frequency features is dependent on the sample rate and
waveform length. When the sample rate is increased, the range is increased and the resolution decreased.
When the waveform length is increased the range is decreased and the resolution is increased. The
waveform length decreases the range because the input to the FFT is kept at 1k (by dropping samples,
effectively reducing the sample rate) to limit the adverse effect of the FFT calculation on processing speed.
The range can also be limited by the front end filters of the system and the choice of sensors used. Bandlimited sensors, like an R15, will limit the frequency ranges around the resonant frequency of the sensor
(150kHz for an R15).
Also, to improve the results of the FFT and eliminate edge effects, the waveform length and pre-trigger
should be set to values which allows for the entire waveform to be captured with no signal at the start and
end of the waveform.
Partial Power Features: Partial Power is a set of (up to 4) waveform and frequency based features each
with a 2 byte value reported in %. Partial Power features are derived from the power spectrum of the
waveform associated with a hit.
Partial Power AE Features are reported as a percentage and is calculated by summing the power
spectrum in a user specified range of frequencies (up to four of these ranges can be specified), dividing it
by the total power (across the full range of frequencies), and multiplying the result by 100.
5.7.2.1
A groupbox called 'Spectrum Features' is located in the Data Sets Menu (see figure 9) just below the Hit
Data Set parameters. This box contains the Partial Power selection and setup boxes. The Data Sets menu
can be reached through the menu structure (Test Setup -> Hardware -> Data Sets). The Partial power
portion of the Spectrum Features box contains:
Copyright 2005, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Junction, New Jersey, USA
- 32 -
a.
b.
c.
Rev. 2
Chapter I Introduction
The partial power features will not be reported in the hit set unless the Partial Powers checkbox is checked
and at least one segment has been defined.
A dialog box called Spectrum Segment Setup (see figure 10) is accessed from the 'Data Sets' dialog box
issued to define the partial power features.
For each of the 4 definable segments the dialog box has a
checkbox to enable the segment, an edit box for defining the
start frequency and an edit box for defining the ending
frequency.
The group box titled 'Total Power Range/Equal Spacing Setup'
contains two edit boxes. These edit boxes serve a dual
purpose. The main reason for them is to define a range of
frequencies over which the power spectrum will be summed.
The result of the summation is used in the calculation of total
power for the partial powers calculation. Their other purpose
is to allow the user to spread the frequency range evenly
among the enabled segments. The spacing will be occur when
the user presses the 'Apply Spacing' push button which is
located to the right of the edit boxes.
CAUTION: If the edit boxes are used to set up equal spacing,
always make sure the edit boxes contain the Total Power range
values when the dialog box 'OK' button is pressed. Otherwise
the partial powers will be based on the equal spacing range.
The dialog box also displays information based on the sample
rate and hit length of the first active AE channel:
1) Effective Sample Rate:
The sample rate of the decimated waveform (the FFT
calculation is always for 1k of samples). For a 1k hit length
the effective sample rate is the same as the hardware sample
rate. For a 2k hit length it would be half the hardware sample
rate. Etc.
Copyright 2005, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Junction, New Jersey, USA
- 33 -
5.7.2.2
Rev. 2
Chapter I Introduction
The Partial Powers can be graphed as a parameter on any of the AEwin display axes, just as any other AE
feature. The quantities have the name FREQPPX, where X is a number from 1 to 4 and corresponds to the
Partial Power calculated from the frequency range defined by the Spectrum Segment for the same number.
The Partial Power is a percentage so the graph title (and cursor readouts) will show FREQPP X% or if that
can't fit FREQPPX% or if that can't fit FPPX. The format of any Partial Power feature in line dump mode
is an integer from 0 to 100. The column header will be FREQPPX.
5.7.3
The Time Driven data set selection boxes are located on the right side of the Data Sets menu dialog box
(figure 9). From this menu, the user can select parametrics and AE Channel Data features, recorded on a
Timed basis, referred to as the Time driven data rate (TDD). The Time Driven data rate is set from the
Rate entry box located near the middle of the Data Sets dialog box. This is the rate at which the Time
driven parameters are recorded and processed by the AE system.
The AE Channel Data features include RMS, ASL, Threshold, and Absolute Energy. Each of these
features have been discussed and defined in section 4.6.1 above. These are useful in monitoring continuous
AE activity. One value is recorded and processed for each active channel during the AE Test.
Time Driven data is important as it gives the user an idea of how the background or continuous AE activity
is changing during time, providing a trending type of result. Absolute Energy is also a valuable parameter
as it provides a summation of energy over time independent of hit activity.
Copyright 2005, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Junction, New Jersey, USA
- 34 -
CHAPTER II
GETTING STARTED
Rev. 2
2.
SYSTEM INSTALLATION............................................................................................................................................ 4
2.1
SAMOS AE System Installation Overview...................................................................................................4
2.2
PCI-8 Board Installation ...................................................................................................................................5
2.3
SAMOS AE System Installation.....................................................................................................................6
2.4
SAMOS AE System Installation Drawings...................................................................................................6
3.
4.
Copyright 2005, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Junction, New Jersey, USA
-1-
1.
Rev. 2
The SAMOS AE system can be delivered in many forms. It may be delivered with as little as a single board with
several software diskettes or as a full system in a -DiSP chassis with up to 16 AE channels, a Benchtop system with
up to 32 channels, a Rugged Portable system with up to 48 channels, or a Large Multichannel system with up to 112
channels. These systems might be equipped with sensors, sensors cables, monitor, keyboard, and mouse. This
chapter will cover these different situations as completely as possible in order to help the user get the system
running with as few problems as possible. Since this chapter is covering installation and set-up of both boards and
complete systems, some sections may not apply. As an example, for the user who has purchased an entire SAMOS
AE system, all PCI-8 boards will be installed and configured and all software will be loaded on the hard disk drive of
the computer. In this case, the user can skip the section on board installation and set-up inside a computer system.
1.1
Remove all components from the shipping cartons. Remove any packing material. Before installing the PCI-8 card(s)
or SAMOS AE system, the user should verify that the system has arrived unharmed and that nothing is physically
loose inside the system enclosure(s). Make sure that everything seems secure and there are no visible signs of
damage to the received components or the shipping containers. If there are loose parts inside the system enclosures,
remove the cover and inspect that all boards are fully seated and connected properly inside the system. DO NOT
APPLY POWER TO THE INSTRUMENT IF YOU ARE UNSURE ABOUT ITS CONDITION. If there are any
questions at all regarding shipment damage or the correct board or connector configuration, please call Physical
Acoustics Customer Service Department immediately.
Carefully Check the delivered parts against your purchase order and our shipping form. Note any back ordered items.
In the event of any discrepancy please notify Physical Acoustics' Customer Service department.
Please identify all the components received against the order and in relation to figure 1 of this chapter, which shows
all the typical components and their connection to form a complete SAMOS AE system. When all components are
fully understood please proceed on to the PCI-8 card and system installation.
1.2
Before proceeding on with the installation of the boards/system, a few caution notes are necessary. These will be
repeated in sections where required as well but should be considered at the start.
1.2.1
AC Power Requirements
Each system has been configured by Physical Acoustics for the voltages specified based on the purchase order or
the country to which the system is going. However, before proceeding to attach any AC operated equipment to your
AC power line, first be sure of the AC voltage levels that you will be connecting to and verify by reading the
manufacturer label on the back panel of each AC unit that it is configured for that voltage. Since the PCI-8 is based
on PC compatible computers and accessories, each unit has a different method of selecting AC voltages. Refer to the
separate users manual for that device if there are any questions. Alternatively, the PAC Customer service department
will be happy to assist you.
A second consideration with AC power is that there are many AC line cords that need to be connected in a SAMOS
AE system. The user should consider placing all the cords into an AC switched (and surge protected) power strip or
AC computer power manager where everything can be turned on and off with a single master power switch.
Copyright 2005, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Junction, New Jersey, USA
-2-
1.2.2
Rev. 2
Ventilation
The PCI-8 cards are based on high performance powerful integrated circuits which do generate and are susceptible to
heat. All systems configured by PAC have been configured with adequate cooling and ventilation in both the PCOlive computer based systems and the industrial chassis to dissipate that heat and assure reliable continuous
operation.
For those users who are installing PCI-8 cards in their own computers, it is required to place the boards in an area of
the computer where an additional fan can be installed. On multiple PCI-8 card installations, PAC normally installs a
cooling fan so that it blows air through each of the PCI-8 cards, parallel to the length of the card. This allows
continuous air flow to blow past the critical integrated circuits on all the PCI-8 cards and draw heat from the heat
sinks or IC surfaces so that they can maintain a cool temperature.
For those users who have bought a complete system from PAC with PCI-8 cards already installed, please do not
remove the fan or its power and do not move the boards to other PC slots inside the computer. Either of these
actions may cause a board cooling problem.
1.2.3
The SAMOS AE system as delivered, is composed of hardware boards, components, software and accessories that
are PC compatible and carry their own documentation and installation instructions. These components include but
are not limited to the computer main-board, video board, color monitor, hard disk drive, keyboard, mouse, WINDOWS
and Printer. PAC has installed these items using a factory default configuration so that it performs its basic operation
in conjunction with the rest of the system. The user should go through all the documentation to be aware of the
hardware and software received, follow any precautionary notes and refer to the documentation if it is desired to
change any system configuration. Finally the documentation should be kept in a safe place for later reference and
use. This will avoid panic calls to the factory.
Copyright 2005, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Junction, New Jersey, USA
-3-
2.
Rev. 2
SYSTEM INSTALLATION
When setting up the system for the first time, it is suggested that the system be set up in a convenient place so that
the user can perform some trial tests in order to get familiar with the installation, set-up, operation and software. This
section assumes the full SAMOS AE system receipt and installation.
Set up the system in accordance with Fig. 1. The following sub-sections provide additional setup information and
instructions on each subsystem in the SAMOS AE system.
2.1
On all delivered SAMOS AE systems including the PAC Benchtop based system, the Rugged Portable AE system,
the Large Multichannel system, the -DiSP based system or a PAC Olive based computer, Physical Acoustics
manufacturing has pre-set and pre-tested the system or PC-Olive computer and there is no need in gaining internal
access to the computer. In this case manufacturing has done the following:
1.
2.
3.
4.
Computer Installation and Testing: Installed all the computer related cards, hard drive and floppy disk
drives into the unit, installed the WINDOWS operating system software and mouse driver software. In
addition this computer and all of its peripherals have been fully set up for operation at the users required AC
line voltage and fully pre-tested.
Computer Options Installation: Any computer related hardware and software options that were selected for
use with the PC-Olive (PC-Computer) and SAMOS AE system, were installed and tested. This includes
adding and testing additional memory, larger hard disk drive, modem and software, printer and printer driver,
etc.
PCI-8 Installation and Testing: All PCI-8 boards ordered for the SAMOS AE system have been configured,
installed and tested along with the required Real Time control daisy chain ribbon connector that must attach
between each of the PCI-8 boards in the system. In addition, PAC has labeled the rear panel SMB
connectors of the computer with the channel numbers based on the PCI-8 board configuration so that the
user knows which channel is which in the system. Finally, PAC has installed extra cooling in the computer
needed for reliable continuous operation of the AE system.
PAC AE Software and Options Installation: All standard AE software has been loaded onto the hard drive
in appropriate directories with appropriate batch files to automatically initiate the PCI-8 software upon
clicking on the icon on the desktop. In addition, all optional software such as 2D-LOC, 3D-LOC, SPHERELOC, TB-LOCwin, AEwinPOST have been enabled and authorized for use in the AEwin software. Likewise,
all external optional programs have been installed with icons. This includes NOESIS, PolyModal, Wavelet
Analysis software and any specific TurnKey application software packages. These will execute upon
selecting the icon.
This, of course, is the easiest way to purchase and install a SAMOS AE system since all the installation details have
been taken care of by Physical Acoustics. In this case the system installation is nothing more than that of
connecting all the external devices to the computer as shown in Figure 1, without the need to worry about installing
the internal components (which is also shown in figure 1).
Copyright 2005, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Junction, New Jersey, USA
-4-
Rev. 2
2.2
If the user has purchased the PCI-8 cards alone and will be installing them in his/her own computer then a similar
installation procedure as that indicated above should be followed after the PCI-8 and all the provided wiring
harnesses are installed. The internal installation then would consist of the following:
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
First, make sure that each PCI-8 board is programmed via its address jumpers to be Board #1, #2 and so on.
Install the PCI-8 cards in the chassis in order, Board #1, #2, etc, making sure that there is adequate ventilation for
a good air movement between the boards.
Install the Real Time Daisy Chain Ribbon cable to attach to each PCI-8, J4 connector in the system. Failure to
do this will result in no Time of test or Hit based parametric transfer between boards.
Connect up the parametric harness to the rear panel in order to gain access to the parametric inputs. If only 2
parametrics are needed, only the first PCI-8 board needs to be connected to the rear panel using the J6 connector
(see figure 1). If 4 parametrics are needed, a harness connecting the first two PCI-8s needs to be connected to
the J6 connector For 6 parametrics, the first 3 PCI-8 cards needs to be connected while for 8 parametrics (the
maximum available), the first 4 PCI-8 boards needs to be connected to the J6 connector.
Connect up the HIT LED harness between each PCI-8 board, J8 connector and the HIT LED panel.
Connect the PAC Audio board into the system.
Make sure that each board is firmly seated and that the hold down screw as well as any hold-down bracket is
properly attached.
Copyright 2005, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Junction, New Jersey, USA
-5-
8.
Rev. 2
In regards to installing the AEwin software, please follow the installation instructions provided in the AEwin
Software Users manual, which is chapter 4 of this manual.
2.3
Assuming that the PC computer(or SAMOS AE System Chassis) has been configured as indicated in the previous
sections then it is ready to be connected to the peripheral items as shown in Figure 1. Most of these connections are
standard ones for installing any PC computer. Also, Physical Acoustics provides labels to show exactly what should
be plugged into a given connector on the SAMOS AE system. Following Figure 1 specific instructions are as
follows:
Once all these connections are made the unit is ready for powering up.
In general, if there are any questions regarding the computer connections or if the user wants a different computer
configuration (Mouse Port, Video Resolution, AC Power, etc.) than that which is supplied as standard, refer to the
manual or instructions that accompany that particular item since all computer related documentation has been
supplied with your SAMOS AE system.
2.4
Figure 2a, b and c shows the front panel of the Benchtop chassis, the Rugged Portable Chassis and the Large
Multichannel system chassiss. On it can be seen a CD-RW Drive, floppy disk drive, and AE Activity LEDs. Figures
3a, b and c shows the rear panel of these same systems, respectively. Note the location of the connectors, position
of the PCI-8 cards, CPU board the PAC Audio card and the peripheral connectors. The PCI-8 cards are installed, in
order, to maintain a consistent numbering sequence. For convenience, all the AE connectors are labeled on Figures
3. All other connections including the computer keyboard, mouse, COM port, video, etc. are usually labeled on the
rear panel for ease in installation. Some of the computer connections shown in the figures may not be identical to the
system delivered as sometimes different CPU boards are used. In cases where there are differences with the
drawings, please refer to the CPU board documentation which has been delivered with the SAMOS AE system.
When installing and connecting up the SAMOS AE chassis, please follow the same instructions as those given in
the previous section (Section 2.1, SAMOS AE system Installation). Although a PC-Olive (PC-Computer) is not
shown in the figures, it will be very similar to the front and rear panel of figures 2a and 3a on the following pages.
Copyright 2005, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Junction, New Jersey, USA
-6-
Rev. 2
Copyright 2005, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Junction, New Jersey, USA
-7-
Rev. 2
Copyright 2005, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Junction, New Jersey, USA
-8-
Rev. 2
Copyright 2005, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Junction, New Jersey, USA
-9-
Rev. 2
Copyright 2005, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Junction, New Jersey, USA
- 10 -
3.
Rev. 2
Once your system has been prepared in accordance with section 2 and assuming that you (or Physical Acoustics)
have properly installed your supplied AEwin software, you are ready to power up the system for the first time. Turn
on the SAMOS AE based system, making sure there are no floppy disks inserted into the disk drive. The correct
power-up sequence is to turn on all items at the same time via a main power switch. If this is unavailable then power
up all peripheral equipment including the CRT monitor, Printer, etc., before powering up the PCI-8 system chassis.
Upon completion of the booting sequence, your computer monitors (on each CRT Monitor) should display a
WINDOWS startup main screen, also known as the desktop. There should be a program group or a series of icons
showing all the programs that are available within the PCI-8 based system. To begin select the AEwin icon or select
Start Programs Physical Acoustics AEwin for PCI-8 from the Start menu.
The computer will display a splash screen temporarily (see figure 4), and then show the AEwin operating screen
(similar to that shown in figure 5).
If this opening screen appears, it means that the AEwin software has been successfully loaded and you can start
working with your new AE system. If the opening screen does not appear or an error message is displayed it means
that either the software has not been installed properly, or authorized. Please recheck your software installation or
call our Customer Service department at 609-716-4000.
For learning how to use and operate AEwin with your SAMOS AE based system, please refer to the AEwin Software
Users Manual which is located as Chapter 4 of this manual. Please also use the help files when in AEwin as a
reference.
Copyright 2005, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Junction, New Jersey, USA
- 11 -
4.
Rev. 2
The PAC Audio/Alarm board contains the alarm and audio controls. The board is standard on the Rugged Portable
Chassis and the Large Multichannel units and is optional on the Benchtop series and -DiSP. The board is usually
located in the rightmost card slot on the rear of the Rugged Portable and Large Multichannel chassis (see figures 3b
and 3c. The Audio/Alarm board can be recognized by the two audio output connectors on the PC backplate of the
board (see figure 3b and 3c). There are no adjustments inside and on the Audio/Alarm board as all controls are under
computer control. Also, the Audio/alarm board needs no external speaker as the board is connected to the Systems
internal speaker. In cases where there is no internal speaker available, the Audio/Alarm board has an on-board
speaker which can be used. If more power is desired, the user can plug in an external speaker to the lower Audio
Output connector. This output is capable of driving a speaker directly. The top Audio output connector (called
Audio Out Low, referring to figure 3b and 3c) can be connected directly to headphones for private listening or can
be connected to a PC computers Audio board input.
The Audio/Alarm circuitry is designed to produce audible tones from high frequency acoustic emission signals. This
circuit can be selected to operate in either a homodyne or heterodyne mode. Operation in heterodyne mode allows
the user to select the frequency of the AE signal to be monitored. Homodyne operation does not require frequency
tuning and allows audio monitoring of AE signals at any frequency. To activate the dialog box for setup of the PAC
Audio Monitor board select 'Test Setup' then 'Audio Monitor...'.
A sample menu is shown in the figure 6.
- 12 -
Rev. 2
or trip level is exceeded (these alarms are defined in the 'Test Setup, Alarms dialog box). By clicking on the Test
Alarm button you can hear how the alarm will sound. Click it a second time turn it back off.
The group titled AE Channel Monitor contains mutually exclusive checkboxes for All Channels and Only
Channel XX operation. When All Channels is selected AE from any channel will produce a tone. When Only
Channel XX" is selected then only AE from the specified channel (XX) will produce a tone. The Signal Gain
combo-box contains a list of valid gain levels for the AE channels. This allows small amplitude AE signals to be
monitored. Squelch acts like a threshold circuit to eliminate the sound of background noise. Valid entries are from
0 to 100%. This value should be set to a level so that under conditions of no AE signals there is no audio output.
Then as soon as a signal received is above the threshold as set by this control the audio output for that signal will be
heard. The scroll bar located under the squelch control can be used as a mouse interface. Clicking on either arrow
changes the squelch by 1%, clicking in the area between the thumb and an arrow changes it by 10%.
The group titled AE Audio Mixing contains mutually exclusive checkboxes for selecting the method by which the
AE tones are generated. When Envelope Detection (Homodyne) mode is selected each hit produces a click sound.
When Frequency Mixing (Heterodyne) mode is selected each hit is mixed with a signal whose frequency is entered
in the edit box below the mode selection controls. This limits the audio to hits whose frequency is 10kHz above the
selected frequency. For example, if the mixing frequency was set to 150kHz then AE signals greater than 150kHz and
less than 160kHz will be heard. The scroll bar located to the left of the frequency control can be used as a mouse
interface. Clicking on either arrow changes the frequency one step at a time, clicking in the area between the thumb
and an arrow changes it by 50 steps. The last control is for volume. It controls the volume of both the A tones and
the alarm tone. It ranges from 0 (off) to 100% (full volume).
The changes made to the dialog box will go into effect immediately. Pressing Cancel will restore the audio settings to
those in effect before the dialog box was displayed. Note that the AE detection by the audio board is independent of
the threshold levels of each channel so it is possible to set the board up to hear AE which is below the threshold of
hits detected during a test.
The top line of the dialog box will display PAC Audio Board Version X.X if a PAC audio board is detected. If one is
not, it will show No PAC Audio Boards Detected. In addition to this dialog box, another menu has been added
which can be displayed during a test to change the audio board settings. This menu is displayed by pressing the
Shift+F6 keys simultaneously while viewing the graphs (it cannot be displayed in the text only line dump mode).
Use the Enter key to change non-numeric values, the +/- keys to change numeric values. The Page up and down
keys will change the heterodyne frequency in larger steps. Pressing the ESC key exits the menu.
Copyright 2005, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Junction, New Jersey, USA
- 13 -
CHAPTER III
SENSORS AND PREAMPLIFIERS
Rev. 2
Copyright
AE SENSORS
&
PREAMPLIFIERS
USERS MANUAL
Rev 0
June 18, 2002
Part # 1220-1001
Rev. 2
5. PREAMPLIFIER INTRODUCTION.......................................................................................................................5
Copyright
Rev. 0
Copyright (C) 2002, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Junction, New Jersey, USA
Rev. 0
Copyright (C) 2002, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Junction, New Jersey, USA
1.
Rev. 0
INTRODUCTION: AE SENSORS
THE MOST IMPORTANT SINGLE FACTOR IN SUCCESSFULLY PERFORMING AN
AE APPLICATION IS THE RELIABILITY OF AN AE SENSOR
High reliability is achieved by PAC's long experience in the successful design and production of numerous
types of electroacoustic sensors for AE research, field and production applications. After years of continuous
research and development by several members of our engineering staff, PAC is now becoming the recognized
leader in the manufacturing of AE sensors. PAC's production flexibility provides the user with a large
selection of transducers to fit many individual applications. The selection of the proper AE sensor depends on
the specific application. Individual specification sheets have been prepared with specific recommended
applications and features. Our engineers are also available to discuss your requirements, and, if necessary, to
custom design sensors for your unique applications at moderate costs.
Copyright
-1-
Rev. 0
3. AE TRANSFER COUPLING
When a sensor has simply been placed on the surface of the material containing the acoustic wave it is found
that the sensor produces a very weak signal. If a thin layer of a fluid is placed between the sensor and the
surface, a much larger signal is obtained. The use of some type of couplant is almost essential for the
detection of low level acoustic signals. Physically, this can be explained by looking at the acoustic wave as a
pressure wave transmitted across two surfaces in contact. On a microscopic scale the surfaces of the sensor
and the material are quite rough, only a few spots actually touch when they are in contact. Stress is force per
unit area and the actual area transmitting a force is very small. If the microscopic gaps are filled with a fluid,
the pressure will be uniformly transferred between the surfaces. For a shear wave with a variable strain
component parallel to the surfaces, again very little strain will be transferred between the surfaces because of
the few points in actual contact. In this case filling the gaps with a low viscosity liquid will not help much
since such a liquid will not support a shear stress. However, a high viscosity liquid or a solid will help
transmit the parallel strain between surfaces. The purpose of a couplant, then, is to insure good contact
between two surfaces on a microscopic level.
A couplant is any material which aids the transmittal of acoustic waves between two surfaces, while a bond is
a couplant which physically holds the sensor to the surface. Water is couplant and cured epoxy resin is a
bond. Many problems have come about from using a bond in an inapplicable way. If a rigid bond is used to
attach a sensor to a sample which elastically deforms during the test, the normal result is a broken bond and
poor or no sensitivity to the acoustic wave. Similarly, in an experiment where the temperature is changed
appreciably, the use of a rigid bonding material can lead to broken bonds due to differential thermal expansion
between the sensor and the sample.
Bonding agents, then, must be chosen with great care and the primary emphasis must be put upon the
compatibility of the materials under the test conditions. Usually if the bond will hold the sensor on, it will be
an adequate couplant. For a compressional wave any fluid will act as a couplant. A highly viscous fluid will
transfer some shear stress across the boundary which may or may not be an advantage. The most practical
rule is to use as a couplant a thin layer of any viscous fluid which wets both surfaces. The sensor should be
held against the surface with some pressure furnished by magnets, springs, tape, rubber bands, etc. The secret
is to use as thin a layer as possible. If a rigid bond is used there must be no differential expansion between the
two surfaces. In Table 3.1 a few commonly used couplants are listed along with the temperature range where
they can be used.
Table 3.1
Some Common Acoustic Emission Couplants and the Approximate
Temperature Range Where They Can Be Used
Dow Corning V-9 resin
-40 to 100 C
High vacuum stop cock grease
-40 to 200 C
Ultrasonic couplants
room temperature
Petroleum grease
room temperature
Water
1 to 99 C
Dow Corning 200 fluid
-273C to -70C and -30C to 200C
Salol
-40C to 40C
Nonaq stop cock grease
-273C to 100C
Dental cement
0 to 50C
50% Indium - 50% Galium mixture
20 to 700C
Copyright
-2-
Rev. 0
Features
4.2
Functional Description
The integral sensors are completely enclosed in a stainless steel case and coated to minimize RFI/EMI
interference. In addition, care has been taken to thermally isolate the critical input stage of the pre-amplifier,
in order to provide excellent temperature stability over the range of -45C to +80C. For ease of use, the
integral sensors utilize a standard coaxial cable with BNC connector to power the pre-amp and carry the
output signal. The complete block diagram of the integral sensor is shown below in Figure 1.
Copyright
-3-
Rev. 0
Specifications
Electrical Specifications:
Gain:
Peak Sensitivity:
Noise (RMS rti):
Dynamic Range:
Output Voltage:
Power Required:
AST Pulse:
AST Trigger:
Completely enclosed crystal
for RFI/EMI Immunity
40 1 dB
30 dB ref 1 V/mBar
~2 V
>80 dB
>15 Vpp into 50 Ohms
28 V at 100 mA
-24 Volt, 0.4 microseconds into crystal
< 2 Volts at preamplifier output (power)
Physical Specifications:
Temperature (C):
Shock Limit (g):
Case material:
Face material:
Grounding:
Connector type:
Connector location:
Directionality (dB):
Seal type
Pressure:
Model Related
Specifications
R6I
R15I
R30I
R50I
WDI
up to 3000 ft.
(1000 m)
up to 1000 ft.
(300 m)
up to 500 ft.
(160 m)
up to 300 ft.
(100 m)
up to 300 ft.
(100 m)
Dimensions
(dia. x ht. (mm)
29 x 40
29 x 31
29 x 31
29 x 30
29 x 30
Dimensions
(dia. x ht. (in.)
1.13 x 1.6
1.13 x 1.23
1.13 x 1.23
1.13 x 1.16
1.13 x 1.16
Weight (gm)
98
70
75
70
70
120 [-26]*
109 [-24.5]*
98 [-24]*
86 [-28]*
87 [-28]*
Operating frequency
range (kHz)
40100
70200
125450
300550
1001000
Resonant frequency
(kHz)1
50 [90]*
125 [153]*
225 [350]*
320 [500]*
125 [500]*
Peak sensitivity
Ref V/m/s)/[Ref V/mbar]
NOTE 1: Denotes response to plane waves (angle of incidence normal to face of sensor).
* Denotes response to surface waves (angle of incidence transverse or parallel to face of sensor).
Copyright
-4-
Rev. 0
5. PREAMPLIFIER INTRODUCTION
Physical Acoustics has a wide range of preamplifiers for use with our systems. There is a need for different
types of preamplifiers due to different applications, specific environmental needs and cost constraints. Below
is a short description of each preamplifier family in PACs line of preamps. Following that is a specification
sheet and additional information regarding each type.
2/4/6 Preamplifier Family: The 2/4/6 preamplifier family includes the 0/2/4 (meaning gain ranges of 0dB,
20 dB and 40 dB) and 2/4/6 (meaning 20 dB, 40 dB and 60 dB gain ranges). Other family members include
the 0/2, 2/4 and 4/6 preamplifiers. This family of preamplifiers is meant to replace the industrys most famous
preamplifier, the 1220A. This is our premiere preamplifier and is meant for laboratory use when the customer
is not sure about the gain that his/her application will need or the frequency bandwidth. These preamplifiers
were designed to be used with all available AE systems that have their power supplied via the output signal
BNC. Provided with three selectable gain settings (switch selectable), this preamplifier operates with either a
single-ended or differential sensor. Plug-in filters provide the flexibility to optimize sensor selectivity and
noise rejection. These filters are supplied in the Low Pass (LP), High Pass(HP) and Band Pass (BP)
configurations, and offer constant insertion loss for easy filter swapping without the need for recalibration.
Auto Sensor Test (AST) allows the sensor to characterize its own condition, as well as send out a simulated
acoustic emission wave that other sensors can detect. Theres also a C version available.
1220 Series Preamplifiers: PACs family of 1220 Preamplifiers offers the versatility of interchangeable
filters for matiching different sensors and dealing with diverse noise environments. Low noise, outstanding
dynamic range and superior techniques for avoiding the pickup of EMI are the cornerstones for PACs longstanding leadership in this vital area. The family of 1220 Preamplifiers features single and differential input,
switchable 40/60 dB gain and replaceable bandpass filters with values from 10 kHz to 1.5 MHz.
There are three versions of the 1220 Preamplifier: the 1220A is powered by +28 volts, which uses the single
BNC for both power and singal. This model has been replaced with the 0/2/4 and 2/4/6 family of
preamplifiers. However, if there is need for this preamplifier to match those already in use, PAC is happy to
supply it.
The 1220B is powered by a separate +/-15 volt source. This uses a BNC connector for signal output and a
Lemo connector for power input.
1220C also separates the power input from the signal output . It uses two separate BNC connectors, one for
28 volt power and one for signal output.
In-Line IL Series Preamplifiers: The In-Line series of preamplifiers are small (~1 square x 2.2 long),
low cost preamplifiers, that are available for those applications where there is a known specific preamplifier
requirement. These preamplifiers have a fixed gain (0, 20, 40 or 60 dB), fixed frequency bandwidth (various
filters are available) and specific sensor input connection (single or differential), all which are specified at the
time of purchase. The result is a very small, simple (just two connectors) and lower cost preamplifier that is
easy to install and use.
1222 Charge Preamplifier: A charge preamplifier is used in cases where there is a need for long lengths of
sensor input cable. Charge preamplifiers do not suffer from distance/attenuation effects like a voltage
preamplifiers do. They maintain the signal amplitude regardless of distance from the passive sensor to the
preamplifier. Our 1222A Charge Preamplifiers work with our entire range of single ended sensors and feature
(internally) selectable 40/60 dB gain, standard PAC Pluggable filters with bandwidths of 20 600 kHz and
built-in test signal and control. They are directly compatible with all PAC systems using the single
Power/signal AE input BNC connection.
1225IS Intrinsically Safe Preamp/Sensors/Barriers: The 1225IS family of components are used in
hazardous, gaseous environments that require chass IIC, Intrinsically safe (IS) apparatus. They are a direct
replacement for the Physical Acoustics standard line of Sensors and 1220A preamplifiers. The IS sensors
(R6-IS, R15-IS and RWD-IS) and the preamplifier (1225A) are designed and certified for use within the
Copyright
-5-
Rev. 0
hazardous area, while the barrier (1225B) is attached to the preamplifier and is installed outside the hazardous
area where it is connected to the AE instrument. Therefore, this series of sensor and preamplifier is used
when the AE system can be installed outside the hazardous area. The 1225A IS preamplifier must be used in
combination with the listed IS sensors and 1225B barrier. It features 20/40 dB selectable gain, pluggable
High Pass and Low Pass filters and operates with PACs standard single Power/Signal BNC.
1227 Series Preamplifiers: This family of preamplifiers offers 20 dB AE signal gain and very low power
operation (3 milliamp typical). The 1227A is designed for standard 50 Ohm AE systems while the 1227B is
designed for 600 Ohm AE systems. Both models use PACs standard single Power/Signal BNC. These
preamplifiers are very small (~ 0.7 square by 2.5 long) and low cost.
1227WT Preamplifier: The PAC 1227WT preamplifier offers 20dB AE signal gain like the 1227A with the
exception that it operates in a wide temperature range of -47C to +175C. Also there is an optional pulse
Through
sensor
calibration
capability.
5.1 0/2/4 & 2/4/6 Preamplifiers
5.1.1
Description
Electrical Specifications:
Gain Selectable: 0/2/4 - 0/20/40 dB + 0.5% dB
2/4/6 20/40/60 dB + 0.5% dB
Input Impedance: 10k // 15pF
Power Required: 18-28Vdc
Operating Current: 30mA (With AST Installed)
28mA (Without AST Installed)
Dynamic Range: 75dB (Utilizing an R15 Sensor)
80dB (50 Input)
Copyright
Environmental Specifications:
Temperature: - 40 C to + 65 C
Physical Specifications:
5 1/2in(L) x 2 3/8(W) x 1 3/8(H)
13.97cm x 6.03cm x 3.49cm
Weight: 0.45lb (205grams)
-6-
Rev. 0
20dB
40dB
60dB
Bandwidth (-3dB):
10kHz-2.5MHz
Output Voltage (50 Load):
20Vpp
CMRR (500kHz):
42dB
Noise(RMS rti):
10kHz-2.0MHz
20Vpp
42dB
10kHz-900kHz
6Vpp
42dB
Filter Frequency
Response
Hz
20dB
With R15
Sensor
40dB
With R15
Sensor
60dB
With R15
Sensor
20dB
Input
Shorted
40dB
Input
Shorted
60dB
Input
Shorted
135k-185k
3 V
1.4 V
1.5 V
2.0 V
1.0 V
0.42 V
100k-300k*
3 V
1.8 V
1.8 V
2.3 V
1.0 V
0.8 V
10k-2.0M
5 V
4 V
3 V
4 V
3 V
2.5 V
*Standard filter
0/2/4 Gain Related Specifications:
Gain Selection
0dB
20dB
40dB
Bandwidth (-3dB):
10kHz-2.5MHz
Output Voltage (50 Load):
3Vpp
CMRR (500kHz):
29dB
Noise(RMS rti):
10kHz-25MHz
20Vpp
29dB
Filter Frequency
Response
Hz
0dB
With R15
Sensor
20dB
With R15
Sensor
40dB
With R15
Sensor
0dB
Input
Shorted
20dB
Input
Shorted
40dB
Input
Shorted
135k-185k
20 V
4.8 V
3.5 V
20 V
4.3 V
2.7 V
100k-300k*
20 V
6.2 V
5.2 V
20 V
5.8 V
4.5 V
10k-2.0M
30 V
19.5 V
11 V
30 V
19 V
10 V
5.1.3
10kHz-800kHz
20Vpp
28dB
The 0/2/4 and 2/4/6 use similar pluggable filters as the 1220A. Please refer to section 5.7 for standard filter
values available for this preamplifier, however, use part number 2-14-40 rather than 1220A when
specifying filters for this family. Also refer to the section 5.7 of the 1220A preamplifier documentation for
installation of filters as well as preamplifier installation.
Copyright
-7-
5.2
5.2.1
Rev. 0
Specifications
Physical Specifications:
3.25in.(L) x 1.13in.(W) x 0.86in.(H)
(8.26cm x 2.87cm x 2.22cm)
Weight: 0.12lb (54 grams)
Electrical Specifications:
Gain : 0, 20, 40 and 60 dB + 0.5% dB
Input Impedance: 10k // 15pF
Power Required: 18-28Vdc
Operating Current: 30mA (With AST Installed)
28mA (Without AST Installed)
Dynamic Range: 80dB (Utilizing an R15 Sensor)
90dB (50 Input)
Gain
Output Voltage (50 Load):
CMRR (500 kHz):
Noise(RMS rti):
5.2.3
IL-D
0 dB
Environmental Specifications:
Temperature: - 40 C to + 65 C
IL-20D
20 dB
IL40D
40 dB
15Vpp
50 dB
2 V
IL60D
60 dB
15Vpp
50 dB
2 V
Standard Filters
Filters for the In-line differential preamplifiers are installed at the factory. Filter values must be specified
at the time of purchase. The following are the standard available filter bandwidths for the In-Line
differential preamps.
20 100 kHz
100 1200 kHz
20 1000 kHz
135 185 kHz
50 500 kHz
250 350 kHz
Contact the factory for values other than those listed above.
Copyright
-8-
Rev. 0
Installation of the In-line differential sensors are very easy since there are only two connectors to connect
and no configuration switches. Simply connect a differential sensor to the input of the of the preamplifier
and connect the output of the preamplifier to the AE system channel input.
5.3
5.3.1
Specifications
Physical Specifications:
3.25in.(L) x 1.13in.(W) x 0.86in.(H)
(8.26cm x 2.87cm x 2.22cm)
Weight: 0.12lb (54 grams)
Electrical Specifications:
Gain:
Input Impedance:
- Input type:
Power Required:
Operating Current:
Dynamic Range:
Output Voltage (50 Load):
Noise(RMS rti):
40 dB + 0.5% dB (Fixed)
10k // 15pF
Single ended inputs (signal and ground)
18-28Vdc
22mA (With AST Installed)
20mA (Without AST Installed)
>80dB (Utilizing an R15 Sensor)
15Vpp
<2 V
Environmental Specifications:
Temperature: - 40 C to + 65 C
5.3.3
Standard Filters
Filters for the In-line single ended preamplifiers are installed at the factory. Filter values must be specified
at the time of purchase. The following are the standard available filter bandwidths for the In-Line single
ended preamps.
15 65 kHz
350 650kHz
30 165 kHz
32 1100 kHz
Contact the factory for values other than those listed above.
Copyright
-9-
Rev. 0
Installation of the In-line single ended preamplifiers are very easy since there are only two connectors to
connect and no configuration switches. Simply connect a single ended sensor to the input BNC of the of
the preamplifier and connect the output BNC of the preamplifier to the AE system channel input. Be
careful not to reverse the connections as damage may occur.
5.4
5.4.1
Both voltage preamplifiers and charge preamplifiers can be used in AE applications. The voltage
preamplifier is more stable, and easier to use then the charge preamplifier, but the charge preamplifier has
some features that make it more desirable for certain applications.
The charge preamplifier has a distinct advantage with long lengths of input cable between the sensor and
the preamplifier. For the example where a sensor coax cable length needs to be e.g. 50 meters, the voltage
preamplifier (1220A) has a 17 dB loss in signal amplitude, where as the charge preamplifier has no loss in
signal amplitude. This has been tested with an R15 sensor with a lead break from a 0.3 mm Pentel
mechanical pencil.
The noise of a charge amplifier is slightly larger then the voltage amplifier due to the addition of an
additional charge conversion stage. Also the length of cable affects the noise.
With a 3' input cable the Signal to Noise Ratio (S/N) of a charge amp is 5 dB smaller then the voltage amp.
With a 150' input cable the signal to noise ratio of the charge amp and voltage amp is the same. The charge
amplifier has the advantage in that the signal amplitude is unchanged.
5.4.2
The figure shows the outline of the 1222 Charge Preamplifier. It has 3 single ended BNC connectors for
use with Co-axial cables. The pre-amp accepts inputs from PAC and other single ended AE piezoelectric
sensors anywhere in the frequency range of 20 - 600 kHz. The following is a description of each of the
connections.
PWR IN
SIGNAL
OUTPUT
SENSOR
INPUT
1222
CHARGE
PREAMPLIFIER
TEST
SIGNAL
POWER
Sensor Input.
This is the input from the AE single ended sensor.
connector.
Copyright
- 10 -
Rev. 0
5.4.3
Uses PAC pluggable Band Pass filters for a narrower frequency response which further
enhances Signal to Noise and filters out unwanted lower frequency vibrations. See
1220A filter selections.
Specifications
Gain:
Bandwidth (-1dB)
RMS Noise (RTI):
Dynamic Range:
Maximum Output:
Quiescent Current:
Filter Module:
Gain Accuracy:
Test Signal:
20K-600kHz
<10 V
80 dB
16 Volts peak to peak into 50 Ohms
35 mA
Requires standard PAC Passive Filters
+/-1dB
Constant Sine Wave (1MHz Bandwidth) 0.5V-P Maximum Amplitude
(set at 150 kHz)
5.4.4
Installation of the 1222 Charge Preamplifier is identical to that of any other typical preamplifier. Attach
the single ended sensor to the signal input of the preamplifier. Then connect the Power In/Signal Out BNC
to the AE system via a co-ax cable. For the test signal, connect a switched 12 volt power source to the Test
signal input. Whenever power is applied, a relay will switch the sensor input to the output of a signal
generator and the signal generator signal will be amplified by the preamplifier and sent to the AE system
for determination if the preamplifier gain or performance has changed.
The 1222 Charge preamplifier uses the standard 1220 family of pluggable filters. Refer to section 5.7 for
specific information relating to the selection and installation of filters in this preamplifier.
5.5
5.5.1
This family of preamplifiers offers 20 dB AE signal gain and very low power operation (3 milliamp typical).
The 1227A is designed for standard 50 Ohm AE systems while the 1227B is designed for 600 Ohm AE
systems like the PAC 4610. It has been designed to be used with single ended sensors only and has a fixed
Copyright
- 11 -
Rev. 0
gain of 20 dB. Several filter bandwidths are available and must be specified at the time of purchase. Both
models use PACs standard single Power/Signal BNC. These preamplifiers are very small (~ 0.7 square by
2.5 long) and very low cost.
5.5.2
Specifications:
Parameter
Output Impedance
Gain
Noise ( Volts RTI):
Maximum Voltage Output (Vp-p):
Dynamic Range:
Supply Voltage Range:
Supply Current:
1227A
50 Ohms
20 dB 1dB
4 V
5 Vp-p
95 dB
9 28 Volts
3 mA @ 12 Volts
0C - 85C
3.4 Long x 0.687 wide x 0.687 high
(8.64 cm long x 1.75 cm wide x 1.75 cm high)
5.5.3
1227B
600 Ohms
20 dB 1 dB
4 V
1.4 Vp-p
84 dB
7 28 Volts
3 mA @ 12 Volts
Standard Filters
Filters for the 1227 series, single ended preamplifiers are installed at the factory. Filter values must be
specified at the time of purchase. The following are the standard available filter bandwidths for the 1227
preamps.
30 200 kHz
60 400 kHz
Contact the factory for values other than those listed above.
5.5.4
Installation of the 1227 single ended preamplifiers are very easy since there are only two connectors to
connect and no configuration switches. Simply connect a single ended sensor to the input BNC of the of
the preamplifier and connect the output BNC of the preamplifier to the AE system channel input. Be
careful not to reverse the connections as damage may occur.
5.6
5.6.1
The Wide Temperature Preamplifier was designed to be used in very extreme temperature environments. It
is for use with all available AE systems that has its power and output signal on the center conductor. Both
input and outputs of the 1227WT utilize SMA type connector (BNCs are optional). The preamplifier is
built in a narrow diameter stainless steel tube for reliability and ruggedness. It is supplied with 20 dB gain
and operates with a single ended sensor (only). Pulse through Sensor Testing provides the ability to allow a
pulse to travel from the AE system through the preamplifier to the sensor. The magnitude of the impulse
going through the preamplifier can be up to 200 volts.
5.6.2
Specifications
Environmental Specifications:
Temperature:
Vibration:
Shock:
Copyright
- 12 -
Rev. 0
20 dB + 1 dB
<40kHz to >1.2 MHZ
10k // 15pF
18-24 VDC
Dynamic Range:
22-23 VDC
< 35 mA (With Pulse through relay)
Physical Specifications:
Length
Diameter
Weight
Connector
Copyright
- 13 -
Rev. 0
Below is a table showing the different values of high pass, low pass, and band pass filters available for these
preamplifiers.
STANDARD PLUG-IN FILTERS
HIGH PASS
PART #
FREQUENCY
1220-3H
3 kHz
1220-20H
20 kHz
1220-50H
50 kHz
1220-100H
100 kHz
1220-200H
200 kHz
1220-300H
300 kHz
1220-400H
400 kHz
1220-500H
500 kHz
1220-600H
600 kHz
5.7.1.
BAND PASS
PART #
FREQUENCY
1220-20-100BP
20-100 kHz
1220-50-200BP
50-200 kHz
1220-100-300BP
100-300 kHz
1220-100-1200BP
100-1200 kHz
1220-200-400BP
200-400 kHz
1220-300-600BP
300-600 kHz
1220-400-600BP
400-600 kHz
1220-600-1200BP
600-1200 kHz
1220-BP-SYS
No Filtering
LOW PASS
PART #
FREQUENCY
1220A-400L
400 kHz
Environmental Specifications:
Specifications apply at 25 5 C
Preamplifiers will operate from 0 to 50 C
Electrical Specifications:
Gain:
Bandpass:
Input:
Input Impedance:
Output Voltage:
Dynamic Range:
CMRR (500 kHz):
Noise (RMS RTI):
Power Requirements:
DC Standby Current:
40 or 60 dB (Switch selectable)
User selectable from 10 kHz to 1.2 MHz
Single or differential selectable
10 k Ohms in parallel with 15 pF
>15 Vpp into 50 Ohms
85 dB
55 dB
<2 V (input shorted)
1220 A, C - +28 VDC
1220B - 15 VDC
25 mA
Physical Specifications:
Dimensions:
Weight:
5.7.2.
Copyright
- 14 -
Rev. 0
AE Differential Input Connector Connects an external differential sensor (PAC RD, D, WD, or
TD series or equivalent piezoelectric transducer) to the 1220 preamplifier via differential BNC
connector.
Power Signal Cable Output signal and power (+28 VDC) are both present on this line. Both signals
are isolated internally. Cable connects via an industry standard BNC connector (PAC 1234 cable).
Gain Select A total preamplifier gain of 40 dB (x100) or 60 dB (x1000) is selected by this switch.
Output Output signal is present here. Cable connects via a standard BNC connector (PAC 1234
cable).
Copyright
- 15 -
Rev. 0
Power +15 VDC is connected to the preamplifier here via a multipin connector. Use PAC cable
#1233 or #1233A.
Pin #1 - Ground 1
Pin #4 - (-15) Volts (Green Lead on 1233 Cable)
Pin #7 - (+15) Volts (Red Lead on 1233 Cable)
Note: When using a 1220B preamplifier with a normally supplied 1233 power cable, no ground
connection is made through the cable. Only a shield is provided in order to prevent possible ground
loop problems (increased noise in the system). The ground is made through the shield or ground of
the Output BNC connection (1234).
Power (+28) VDC is connected to the preamplifier here via a standard BNC cable (PAC #1234 or
#1234A).
Figure 7 shows wiring connections of the preamplifiers. Look up the corresponding number that describes the
connection or control.
Copyright
- 16 -
Rev. 0
Connect a 1234 BNC to BNC signal cable from the preamplifier "Output" to the jack marked "AE IN" on
the analyzer.
Select the AE input desired (single or differential).
Attach the appropriate sensor and cable to the preamplifier input connector (single or differential).
Turn system power on to energize the preamplifier.
Connect a 1233 power cable from the 1220B connector labeled "Power to the PAC analyzer connector
labeled Pre-Amp Power."
Connect a 1234 BNC to BNC cable from the preamplifier connector "Output" to the one on the analyzer
labeled "AE IN."
Select the AE input desired (single or differential).
Attach the appropriate sensor and cable to the preamplifier input connector (single or differential).
Turn system power on to energize the preamplifier.
Connect a 1234 (or 1234A BNC to pigtail) cable from the 1220C connector marked "Power" to an
external +28 VDC power supply.
Connect a 1234 BNC to BNC signal cable from the preamplifier connector "Output" to the one on the
analyzer labeled "AE IN."
Select the AE input desired (single or differential).
Attach the appropriate sensor and cable to the preamplifier input connector (single or differential).
Turn the system and external supply power on to energize the preamplifier.
Copyright
- 17 -
5.7.4.
Rev. 0
Filter placement on the 0/2/4, 2/4/6 and 1220A, B, and C are identical. To replace a filter, remove the four
Phillips head screws from the bottom lid; this will expose the preamp's inner circuitry (Figure 8).
The connections shown in Figure 9. should be made in order to by-pass (remove) filter in cases where the
broadest possible bandwidth is desired.
Copyright
- 18 -
5.7.5.
Rev. 0
Circuit Description
Figure 10. is a block diagram of the 1220 series preamplifier. Internal circuitry for the 1220 A, B, C. is
identical except for minor differences in the output and power distribution sections.
Input Select Input selection consists of a low noise differential amplifier for high gain, high common
mode rejection and maximum sensitivity to low level input signals. This amplifier is then buffered by a
20 dB gain low output impedance post amplifier, which drives the PAC plug-in fifth order high pass, low
pass and bandpass filters.
Gain Select The output stage consists of a hybrid 20/40 dB gain high speed amplifier and a 50 Ohm
output buffer for large power bandwidth while driving long cables. Two user adjustments are provided
for calibration.
Copyright
- 19 -
Rev. 0
Competing methods for sensor pulsing or automated testing in AE instruments involves the use of at least 2
relays for each channel, one in the AE system for each channel and one in each pre-amplifier. When the
AE system decides to pulse the sensor, it turns on a relay in the AE instrument which removes preamplifier power and makes connection to a digital output which puts a voltage spike through to the preamplifier. A relay in the pre-amplifier de-energizes when power is removed from the pre-amp. This causes
the relay contacts to make electrical connection to the sensor crystal directly, and remove the pre-amp
output signals from the co-axial cable path. A voltage spike now goes directly to the sensor crystal. Upon
pulsing, a simulated AE event is generated that is coupled to the structure in which that sensor was in
contact. This causes other sensors that are close by to detect the simulated AE event. This data when
processed by the AE system gives the user information about the quality of the sensors that have detected
the event. When used often, the user can determine if there has been any sensor degradation during the AE
test. Unfortunately this technique is inferior to Auto sensor testing for various reasons including the fact
that it cannot be used in situations where only one sensor is involved as well as other reasons that will be
discussed below.
6.2
PAC has improved on the automated pulsing method with a unique and different scheme we call Auto
Sensor Test (AST). Our scheme keeps the pulsing sensor active immediately after pulsing. This offers the
following advantages in characterizing the AE event response:
1.
2.
3.
4.
Reading the response from the same sensor that is being pulsed gives a quality measure
of that given AE channel. This includes information on sensor, coupling pre-amplifier
and AE system.
A single sensor can be evaluated whereas in the above relay based method, this is
impossible.
The self pulsing/receiving method provides information on the coupling quality of the
sensor to the structure, whether the sensor is even attached to the cable or if the cable is
shorted.
Since the pulsing sensor receives the AE information, it is the first hit sensor. This gives
exact "delta T" measurements from this sensor to each other that detects the event. This
is useful in calibrating for location. It is also useful in performing measurements such as
those used in Acousto-Ultrasonics where the change in flight time is an important feature.
The way that this is accomplished is simply by sending a pulse down the preamplifier cable to the
preamplifier. If the amplifier is equipped with AST capability, it has a circuit that detects this pulse. When
detected, this pulsing circuitry generates a pulse with a specific pulse shape that excites the AE sensor.
Since AE sensors work equally well as pulsers or receivers, the pulse causes the AE sensor crystal to
deform and generate shock waves that travels throughout the structure. These sound waves travel to
sensors that are on the structure and reflect, even back to the orignial pulsing sensor. The pulsing sensor
which immediately reverts to a receiving AE sensor at the end of the pulse, receives the structural response
Copyright
- 20 -
Rev. 0
signals and they are processed as a typical AE hit or event. Other sensors on the structure also detect and
process the event.
The main disadvantage to the AST method is the receiving of the "main bang". This saturates the peak
amplitude response of the AE system so that the pulsing sensor always registers a ~100 dB amplitude, but
since this is a high "Q" type response, all the other AE features remain very low in value from the main
bang alone. In this way, energy, duration and counts becomes a very good parameter for monitoring the
response of the pulse.
6.3
AST Requirements
AST (Auto Sensor Test) circuitry in the AE system. This is built as standard within all
PAC multi-channel AE systems including DiSP, MISTRAS, LAM, SPARTAN 2000.
Preamplifiers with AST option or Integral Preamplifier Sensors with AST Option,
(AST) Auto Sensor Test Software. This is built standard within all PAC multi-channel
AE System software including DiSP, MISTRAS, LAM and SPARTAN 2000.
From the above it can be seen that AST circuitry and software is already built into most PAC systems and
is immediately ready to be put to good use. The only item that may have to be purchased is the
preamplifier with AST option or the Integral Preamplifier sensors with the AST Option. PAC sells AST
options with its 0/2/4 and 2/4/6 preamplifiers, its In-Line Preamplifiers, and with the 1220A preamplifiers.
It is also available with our Integral Preamp sensors such as the R15I-AST, R30I-AST, WDI-AST, etc.
Please consult PAC for more information on closing the loop with our AST preamplifiers and integral
sensors.
In terms of software, all PAC multi-channel software has multiple AST modes. AST can be performed
before and after a test providing a graphical or line dump report. AST can even be performed during a test
on a single sensor or all sensors to verify their integrity, all without affecting the AE test results. One
additional mode with AST is the ability of saving a previous test to use as a comparison with a later AST
test. In this way, a nice report is generated to indicate the statistical deviation from the Trained file and
provide pass/fail information as a result. Consult your software manual for more information on the use of
AST in PACs multichannel AE systems.
Copyright
- 21 -
Rev. 0
Introduction
Physical Acoustics 1224 series repeater amplifiers are "in-line" driver amplifiers meant to restore the AE
signal level when driving long co-ax cables. The 1224 was developed for use with Acoustic Emission (AE)
systems in production and laboratory applications. Its circuitry uses low noise and high reliability
components. The 1224 series repeater amplifier has been specifically designed to compensate for signal
losses over long cable lengths. It is used between the AE system and the AE preamp when cable lengths
exceed 1000 feet. Therefore it is recommended that 1224's be used at spacing of 1000 feet.
7.2
Specifications
Typical specifications for the 1224 series repeaters are as shown below:
1224 Specifications @ 28 Volts
Gain:
Frequency response (-3 dB):
10 dB min. or 20 dB max.
1.6 kHz to 2.5 MHz small signal
1.6 kHz to 1.0 MHz large signal
8 Vpk-pk into 50 Ohms
2038 mA, depending on gain setting
1428 Volts DC
23 V (No filter)
14 V (with "100 kHz low" filter)
1224 Configurations/Designations
There are several different models of 1224 as shown in the feature chart below.
Feature Chart
Combined supply/
signal line
Separate
supply line
External
gain adjust
Internal
gain adjust
Frequency range
1224A
Yes
1224B
Yes
1224C
No
Yes
1224C-LF
Yes, on
differential
BNC connector
Yes*
No
No
10 or 20 dB
Fixed at 20 dB
3 to 20 dB
10 to 900 kHz
10 to 700 kHz
1224D
Yes
No
None
10 or 20 dB
10 or 20 dB
0 or 20 dB
3 to 20 dB
3 to 20 dB
3 to 20 dB
3 to 20 dB
10 kHz to
1.6 kHz to
10 kHz to
1 MHz
1 MHz
1 MHz
Input
50 Ohm or
50 Ohm or
50 Ohm or
50 Ohm or
50 Ohm or
5 kOhm
5 kOhm
5 kOhm
5 kOhm
5 kOhm
* On the differential BNC Connector, one conductor is for power and the other for the AE signal. Please note
that using this repeater requires different cabling and connectors on the 5600. The main advantage of using
this repeater is in applications where a very low frequency operation is desired.
Copyright
- 22 -
7.4
Rev. 0
The 1224 series repeater consists of a low noise preamplifier with an internally adjustable gain to compensate
for filter losses. The output of the preamplifier drives a PAC plug-in filter module. The plug-in filter module
can be replaced by removing the four Phillips head screws from the bottom lid. Various high-pass, low-pass
and bandpass filter configurations are available to customize the 1224 frequency response. These are the
same filters as indicated in the previous section. The filter output is then fed to the output stage. The output
stage consists of a hybrid 10 or 20 dB gain high speed amplifier and a 50 Ohm output buffer for large power
bandwidth while driving long cables.
The 1224 repeater amplifier can be installed by simply connecting the output of the repeater amplifier toward
the jack of the analyzer marked "A.E. Input." The input of the 1224 amplifier should then be connected
towards the sensor or preamplifier output. The external gain switch can then be used to control the amount of
gain.
Copyright
- 23 -
CHAPTER IV
AEWIN SOFTWARE
AEwin Software
USERS MANUAL
Rev 1.9
September 20, 2004
PAC Part # : 6320 1006
AEwin
TM
TM
.. .. .. the
the Next
Next Generation
Generation in
in AE
AE Software
Software .. .. ..
A
A typical
typical activity
activity
screen
screen with
with both
both AE
AE
features
features and
and wavewaveforms,
forms, processed
processed
with
with aa simple
simple mouse
mouse
click
click for
for any
any specific
specific
hit.
hit.
AEwin
AEwin Software,
Software,
combined
combined with
with
advanced
advanced Digital
Digital
Signal
Signal Processing
Processing
hardware,
hardware, enables
enables
the
the AE
AE user
user to
to select
select
and
and view,
view, in
in real
real
time,
time, multiple
multiple 2-D
2-D or
or
3-D
3-D feature
feature and
and
waveform
waveform activity
activity
graphs.
graphs.
AEwins
AEwins 3-D
3-D graphgraphing
ing capability
capability allows
allows
the
the graph
graph to
to be
be
rotated
rotated freely,
freely, using
using
the
the mouse.
mouse.
AEwin
AEwin Software
Software
Call
Call (609)
(609) 716-4000,
716-4000,
Email us: sales@pacndt.com or
Visit us on the Web at:
www.pacndt.com
Greatly expanded the section detailing the menus and dialog boxes.
Revised the location and clustering sections.
Added sections on various AEwin options (Supervisor mode, LeakTEC/OnLine Crack Alarms, etc.
Updated license Activation section to include info on Hardware Security
Keys.
Added section on PCI-2 Waveform Streaming.
Added Hit/Event Linking Analysis Capability
AEwin SOFTWARE
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
Table of Contents
1.
INTRODUCTION.................................................................................................................................................................. 1
1.1
System Requirements .................................................................................................................................................... 2
1.2
Software Installation...................................................................................................................................................... 2
1.2.1
Installing AEwin from the installation CD: .......................................................................................................2
1.2.2
Activate the AEwin software using the Start Menu option.............................................................................3
1.2.3
Installing the Data Acquisition Board driver if you are doing acquisition ...................................................5
1.2.4
Installing the PAC Audio board driver if using the Audio Board ..................................................................5
1.2.5
Warning Notes.........................................................................................................................................................5
1.2.6
Installing a Shortcut Icon for AEwin on the Desktop.......................................................................................5
1.2.7
Upgrading AEwin Software Using the Existing License Code......................................................................6
2. AEwin LAYOUT (.LAY) FILES AND DATA (.DTA) FILES ..................................................................................... 7
3. OPERATING AEwin ............................................................................................................................................................. 8
3.1
Starting AEwin ............................................................................................................................................................... 8
3.2
AEwin Screen Layout Familiarization ....................................................................................................................... 9
3.3
Navigating the AEwin Menus.................................................................................................................................... 10
3.3.1
File Menu ...............................................................................................................................................................10
3.3.2
Acquisition Setup Menu ......................................................................................................................................12
3.3.3
Acquire/Replay Menu..........................................................................................................................................32
3.3.4
Graphing Menu .....................................................................................................................................................35
3.3.5
Tables Menu ..........................................................................................................................................................39
3.3.6
View Menu.............................................................................................................................................................39
3.3.7
Utilities Menu........................................................................................................................................................39
3.3.8
Page Menu..............................................................................................................................................................39
3.3.9
Window Menu.......................................................................................................................................................39
3.3.10
Help Menu..............................................................................................................................................................39
3.4
Acquiring AE Data with AEwin for the First Time ............................................................................................... 40
3.4.1
Loading a Layout File into AEwin ....................................................................................................................40
3.4.2
Entering Acquisition ............................................................................................................................................40
3.4.3
Actions within Data Acquisition........................................................................................................................42
3.4.4
Exiting Data Acquisition .....................................................................................................................................45
3.5
Operational Sequence of Replaying AE Data ......................................................................................................... 45
3.5.1
Loading a Layout File into AEwin ....................................................................................................................46
3.5.2
Entering Replay.....................................................................................................................................................46
3.5.3
Actions within Replay..........................................................................................................................................46
3.5.4
Exiting Replay.......................................................................................................................................................46
3.6
Using Line Listing Mode............................................................................................................................................ 46
3.6.1
Enabling Line Dump Listing for Viewing........................................................................................................47
3.6.2
Modifying The Line Display ..............................................................................................................................48
3.6.3
Sizing and Moving the Line listing Display.....................................................................................................48
3.7
Clustering Setup and Operation................................................................................................................................. 48
3.8
Graphing in AEwin ...................................................................................................................................................... 52
3.8.1
Graph Setup Procedure ........................................................................................................................................53
3.8.2
Screen Page and Tab Management....................................................................................................................54
3.8.3
Adding, Placing and Sizing Graphs on a Screen Page ...................................................................................54
3.8.4
Graph Setup Function ..........................................................................................................................................55
3.9
Hit/Event Linking and the Data Lookup Display Dialog Box............................................................................. 57
3.9.1
Procedure................................................................................................................................................................57
3.9.2
Controls ..................................................................................................................................................................58
3.9.3
Exporting Hits, Waves and Events ....................................................................................................................60
3.9.4
Changing the Time of Arrival of a Waveform and Recalculating an Event...............................................60
3.9.5
Other Features .......................................................................................................................................................60
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
3.9.6
Notes .......................................................................................................................................................................60
3.9.7
Custom Arrival Timing Feature .........................................................................................................................61
3.10 Cluster/Area History.................................................................................................................................................... 62
3.10.1
Setup........................................................................................................................................................................62
3.10.2
Starting a Cluster History Process.....................................................................................................................62
3.10.3
Starting an Area History Process.......................................................................................................................62
3.10.4
Execution................................................................................................................................................................63
3.10.5
Notes .......................................................................................................................................................................63
3.11 Graph Alarms ................................................................................................................................................................ 63
3.11.1
How to setup a graph alarm: ...............................................................................................................................63
3.11.2
How an alarm is detected/triggered:..................................................................................................................63
3.11.3
What happens when an alarm is triggered:.......................................................................................................64
3.11.4
Tips:.........................................................................................................................................................................64
3.12 List of Shortcut Keys................................................................................................................................................... 65
4. LOCATION ........................................................................................................................................................................... 66
4.1
Theoretical Background.............................................................................................................................................. 66
4.2
Location Setup Dialog................................................................................................................................................. 68
4.2.1
General Tab Settings:...........................................................................................................................................69
4.2.2
Timing Tab Settings:............................................................................................................................................71
4.2.3
Distance Units Dialog ..........................................................................................................................................73
4.2.4
Material Properties Dialog ..................................................................................................................................73
4.2.5
Attenuation Dialog ...............................................................................................................................................74
4.2.6
Guard Sensor Dialog ............................................................................................................................................75
4.3
Location View & Sensor Placement Dialog............................................................................................................ 75
4.4
Notes on Regression Location Modes...................................................................................................................... 77
4.4.1
2D Planar & 2D Planar (XY)..............................................................................................................................78
4.4.2
3D Location, 2D Planar (YZ) & 2D Planar (XZ)............................................................................................80
4.4.3
Spherical Location................................................................................................................................................84
4.4.4
Cylinder Location .................................................................................................................................................87
4.4.5
Conical Location...................................................................................................................................................90
4.5
Location Examples....................................................................................................................................................... 93
4.5.1
Set Up and Testing of a Zonal or Linear Location Group.............................................................................94
4.5.2
Setup and Testing of a 2D Planar Location Group .......................................................................................101
4.5.3
Setup and Testing of a Tank Bottom Location Group..................................................................................104
5. OPTIONS FOR AEwin ..................................................................................................................................................... 112
5.1
Supervisor Option ...................................................................................................................................................... 112
5.2
LeakTEC Alarms ........................................................................................................................................................ 112
5.2.1
Setup......................................................................................................................................................................112
5.2.2
Operation..............................................................................................................................................................113
5.2.3
What happens when an alarm is triggered......................................................................................................113
5.3
On-Line Crack Alarms .............................................................................................................................................. 113
5.3.1
Setup......................................................................................................................................................................114
5.3.2
Operation..............................................................................................................................................................115
5.3.3
What happens when an alarm is triggered......................................................................................................115
APPENDIX................................................................................................................................................................................... 116
UTILITIES MENU AEwin SOFTWARE ........................................................................................................................... 116
1.
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
INTRODUCTION
AEwin is a 32 bit WINDOWS, Data Acquisition and Replay program capable of running PACs DiSP, SAMOS, PCI-2,
MISTRAS or SPARTAN based products. AEwin uses full WINDOWS resources including: Setting of any WINDOWS
available screen resolutions, Printing, Networking, Multi-Tasking, Multi-Threading, etc. It is capable of operating in
WINDOWS 98/ME/2000/XP operating systems. AEwin is fully compatible with PACs standard (DTA) data files. This
allows you to replay and analyze all your previously collected AE files. AEwin is easy to learn, operate and use. The
software has all the acquisition, graphing and analysis capabilities that you have come to expect in your AE system, plus
many more new and enhanced features to ease your data analysis and visualization tasks. Multiple copies of AEwin can
be run at once, one for acquisition with full display and analysis capabilities and one or more as Replay for additional
analysis purposes.
Some of the general AE display and analysis capabilities found in AEwins includes the following: AEwin provides a
framework for easily adding graphs and graph screens to the main system WINDOW. AEwin has a very flexible line
dump capability, which can be called at any time, in any screen, which can be scrolled up or down. AEwin has various
user selectable tool bars including; Setup icon toolbar, acquisition control, line dump, status toolbar and statistics tool
bar. AEwin has many built in, enhanced features including; Graph zooming and panning, more flexible graph setup,
more graphs, and built-in filtering functions (graphical filters and Post Filtering). Printing capabilities include: Print a
graph, a screen or multiple screens to a WINDOWS or network printer, to the clipboard or to a JPEG file.
Some of AEwins graphing capabilities include:
Exceptional 2D and 3D graphing capabilities. Multiple graphs can be displayed on a screen, limited only by
the resolution of the screen itself.
Graphs are individually sizable on a screen, making for a very flexible arrangement. The user can set up one
(or more) large graphs for visualization with multiple supporting small graphs alongside or around the main
ones.
Multiple Graphs are arranged on a screen, however the user desires. Multiple screens can be setup, each
accessible by selecting a user labeled tab. Therefore, a user can set themes for screen layout (e.g. Location &
Cluster analysis, waveform analysis, AE activity analysis, AE Feature correlation analysis, Alarm Analysis,
themes to name a few)
Many different types of graphs can be set up including; histograms, point plots, 3-D graphs, waveforms, FFTs,
multiple plots on a single graph with coloring options, etc.
All graphs can easily be enlarged to full screen (maximized) by the touch of a button.
All graphs have full Cursor Readout capability, either continuous or point by point movement.
All graphs (2-D and 3-D included) can be infinitely zoomed and panned for close-up analysis.
In terms of Location determination, the standard version of AEwin has zonal and linear location modes, while the
optional Full Location software adds 2D Planar Location capability to the list. In addition, there is also a 3D
Location option available and a Spherical 3D location option. Key features regarding location include the
following:
Multiple (8) location groups standard, (32 optional), each capable of using all the AE channels in the AE
system. Mouse oriented sensor setup includes; Set sensors manually (click and drop), automated sensor
setup for triangular setup, and easy sensor editing drag and drop, or table entry based sensor position.
Multiple 1 dimensional, 2 dimensional and 3 dimensional location modes.
Flexible Clustering, cluster reporting and Cluster statistics available on any point plot graph screen (not just
limited to location).
User selectable location structure visualization to ease setup. Options include; Plate, vertical vessel,
horizontal vessel, sphere, and Free, each with specific setup menus geared for easy setup of that structure,
including automated and manual placement of sensors, weld lines, nozzles, etc.
Visualization overlay planes to ease setup and viewing of location setup and results. Overlay planes
include; Sensors, grid, attenuation map, welds and nozzles.
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
-1-
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
Advanced Location setup capabilities provides improved event detection classification, and accurate source
location techniques.
The AEwin program runs under WINDOWS 98/ME/2000/XP operating systems. However, the best performance
will be obtained using WINDOWS 2000/XP.
1.1
System Requirements
AEwin software requires a PAC DiSP, SPARTAN, PCI-2, MISTRAS or SAMOS System with Pentium III (or
equivalent). Although lesser system computer configurations will operate AEwin, it is recommended that a 1 GHz
processor, 256 megabytes RAM, 20 gigabyte hard disk and 17 display monitor with 1280 x 1024 resolution be
utilized. These days this type of computer power is easily available at low cost. Please consult the factory if your
computer is below these standards.
If AEwin is being installed explicitly for replay and analysis, it is also recommended to use a similar computer base
as that described above.
1.2
Software Installation
The AEwin program is generally pre-installed on the AE system computer from the factory. In special instances,
such as software upgrades, however, you will need to perform the installation yourself from the supplied CD. You
cannot run AEwin directly from the distribution CD because the files on the disk are compressed and security
protected.
If you are installing AEwin yourself, you will need to follow the simple installation instructions below. Due to the builtin software security features of this software, part of the installation process requires you to obtain an activation code
from Physical Acoustics Corporation. The process is simple, you will be prompted to either call the factory or email the
factory to obtain your security activation code, which you will enter to complete the installation process. This is all
explained below for the example of a DiSP. Other products such as MISTRAS or SPARTAN will be very similar.
To fully install AEwin, you must perform the following steps, after you have exited all running applications.
1.
2.
3.
4.
Run SETUP.EXE from the root directory of the AEwin installation CD disk.
Activate the software using one of two methods:
a) On the last screen of the setup program there is a checkbox for product activation. If this is checked
when you press finish it will run the activator program automatically.
b) To run the activator program manually it can be found at:
Start Menu-->Programs -->Physical Acoustics-->Activate AEwin for DiSP
Install the PCI-DSP4 driver if you are doing acquisition. See below.
Install the PAC Audio driver if using an audio
board. See below.
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
-2-
2.
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
This section discusses the various file types associated with AEwin. The most important files you will be working
with everyday with AEwin are the Setup Files (called Layout files in AEwin) and the Data files. Your working copy
of AEwin will have examples of both these layout files and test data files. You will be creating, using and
modifying these files in the course of your work.
The initialization or setup files, referred to as Layout files, distinguished by the suffix .LAY, hold all AE test setup
information for the AEwin software. A .LAY file stores the hardware setup, graph setup, acquisition setup, filters,
alarms and location setup. Other program settings, such as graph item colors and various preferences are stored in
the Windows registry.
A .LAY file can be loaded from disk by means of the Open Layout option in the File Menu of the AEwin
program. Once loaded, all the initialization information from the layout file immediately becomes effective for
system operation. A .LAY file is written to disk by means of the Save Layout or Save Layout As option in the
File Setup menu. All the initialization information currently established in the system is written to the file. A .LAY
file can have any name followed by the .LAY extension.
There is one special .LAY file known as the Autoload file. It is distinguished by the special name Layout.LAY.
The Autoload file, when present, is automatically read from disk when the AEwin program begins to run. If the
Autoload file is not present, the system is set up with default values held in the AEwin program itself. The Autoload
file is a convenience feature to speed your work.
AE Test Data Files are identified by the filename extension .DTA. You may specify any name for a data file using
standard Windows file naming conventions. This is done in the Start acquisition dialog box from the Acquire Menu.
If a new name is not entered, the system will use the default data file name e.g. TEST0000.DTA for the first data
written after bootup. The next file will be TEST0001.DTA, then TEST0002.DTA, and so on. It is convenient to use
numbers at the end of the filenames (e.g. ABCD000.DTA) as the system will then increment the numbers to help
keep the files in order and organized.
Layout and data files may be written to any disk drive and any specified subdirectory. A good practice is to save
both .LAY files and .DTA files to the same drive and subdirectory, keeping related test files together. It is also a
good practice to name the files very similar (e.g. test.LAY and test0000.DTA) as this will help keep the layout files
organized with the data files.
There has been an intentional name and file-extension change from the Initialization (.INI) file of the Legacy
(DOS) based PAC programs to the Layout (.LAY) file for setup files utilized by AEwin. The file extension for a
data (.DTA) file remains consistent. There is a good reason for this. Due to the extensive changes in migrating to
Windows, and the many, many extra capabilities that have been added to the setting up of the system, it is
impossible to keep consistency in the setup files between the previous legacy software and the AEwin software.
Therefore, to avoid confusion, the extension file name has been changed. Now whenever a user sees an INI file,
they will know that this can only be used with the previous legacy software, while the .LAY layout file can only be
used with the AEwin software.
However, with the DTA file, the compatibility remains between the data file structure and AE .DTA data files can
be read and displayed by either the DOS or the AEwin software.
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
-7-
3.3.1.7
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
Copy Screen to Clipboard is used to save an image of the entire screen to the clipboard. This image can then be
pasted in other applications such as word processors and image editors.
3.3.1.8
Exit
Exit is used to terminate the AEwin program. If you have made any unsaved changes to your current layout
AEwin will prompt you to save your layout first, exit without saving or cancel.
3.3.2
3.3.2.1
Hardware
This is the dialog box where all hardware settings are selected before the test. There are a number of property pages
that each deal with a different part of hardware setup. Each is described below. Note that there are some differences
in this dialog box between products. For instance AEwin for Spartan has a Gain setting but no Waveform Setup
whereas AEwin for DiSP has no Gain setting but can have Waveform Setup if the Waveform option has been
installed. Features specific to one or more types of hardware are noted by the names of the applicable hardware
types. These types are briefly described below.
Name
Description
Waveforms
ICC
2 Channel card for Spartan systems. *
Not Available
DSP4
4 Channel card for Spartan systems. *
Not Available
AEDSP
2 Channel card for Mistras systems.
Standard
PCI-DSP4
4 Channel card for DiSP systems.
Optional
SAMOS
8 Channel card for SAMOS systems.
Standard
PCI-2
2 Channel card for PCI-2 systems.
Standard
* ICC and DSP4 cards can be used simultaneously in the same system.
3.3.2.1.1
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 12 -
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
Enable Collection This checkbox is used to signal the data acquisition board(s) to acquire waveforms. If this
checkbox is unchecked then the board(s) will not be able to collect waveforms for the duration of the test.
Enable Transfer This checkbox is used to signal the data acquisition board(s) to transfer collected waveforms to
the software for processing/display and (if auto-dump is enabled) saving to a data file. If this checkbox is
unchecked then the waveforms will not be visible to the user and wont be saved in a data file until the checkbox is
turned on. Unlike Enable Collection this checkbox can be toggled on/off at any time during a test. When Enable
Transfer is OFF the system can experience a boost in performance especially at high data rates if you are saving to a
data file. Turning Enable Collection OFF can grant a greater performance boost at very high data rates as the system
concentrates on hit-based data.
Spectrum Features
This box is available if you have the waveform option installed. Spectrum Features are derived from the power
spectrum of the waveform associated with a hit:
1) Frequency centroid - the center of mass of the power spectrum graph.
2) Peak frequency - the point where the power spectrum is greatest.
3) Partial Powers - see 'Partial Power Features' below.
You must check Enable Collection in the Waveforms box for these features to be usable. Transfer of waveforms
can still be set off so that the system can record spectrum features without recording waveforms.
Partial Power Partial Power is a feature which is derived from the power spectrum of the waveform associated
with a hit. It is a percentage and is calculated by summing the power spectrum in a specified range of frequencies
(up to four of these ranges can be specified), dividing it by the total power in another range of frequencies, and
multiplying the result by 100.
To use partial power you must
1) Check the partial power checkbox.
2) Define at least one partial power segment. To do this press Define. This brings
up the Spectrum Segment Setup dialog box described below.
Spectrum Segment Setup is used to define the partial power features. For each of the
4 definable segments the dialog box has a checkbox to enable the segment, an edit
box for defining the start frequency and an edit box for defining the ending frequency.
The group box titled 'Total Power Range/Equal Spacing Setup' contains two edit
boxes. These edit boxes serve a dual purpose. The main reason for them is to define
a range of frequencies over which the power spectrum will be summed.
The result of the summation is used in the calculation of total power for the partial
powers calculation. Their other purpose is to allow the user to spread the frequency
range evenly among the enabled segments. The spacing will occur when the user
presses the 'Apply Spacing' button which is located to the right of the edit boxes.
CAUTION: If the edit boxes are used to set up equal spacing, always make sure the
edit boxes contain the Total Power range values when the dialog box 'OK' button is
pressed. Otherwise the partial powers will be based on the equal spacing range.
The dialog box also displays information based on the sample rate and hit length of the first active AE channel:
1) Effective Sample Rate The sample rate of the decimated waveform (the FFT calculation is always for 1k of
samples). For a 1k hit length the effective sample rate is the same as the hardware sample rate. For a 2k hit
length it would be half the hardware sample rate. Etc.
2) Effective Maximum Frequency This is one half that of the Effective Sample Rate and is the maximum
frequency which can be defined for any segment.
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 15 -
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
The DeltaT Filters page is very similar to the Front-End Filters page discussed previously. Four different filters are
available to allow programming of each board differently. Alternatively, the first filter can be chosen aTj 0 TDni1 Tc r
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 19 -
nciis-
3.4
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
This section is provided to help you understand the sequence of getting into and running an AE Test for the first time
using the provided Layout (.LAY) files and also gives you insight into a more detailed sequence of carrying out an AE
data acquisition test. Before starting in acquisition, you should have your AE system already set up as per the Getting
Started section of your AE system manual. This usually entails, connecting sensors, preamplifiers and cables to the
AE system, connecting up your AE system, computer keyboard, mouse and monitor and booting up your system into
AEwin as previously instructed. If you are not ready to connect up the AE system to conduct some type of AE test or
at least any AE experimental test on a laboratory test, then skip this section and proceed to the next major section on
Replaying an AE test with AEwin.
The key to carrying out an AE test is in setting up the hardware set-ups, graphics, location setups and display modes to
your particular requirements prior to entering the test. Although there are many set-up items and they might seem
conf -0.1810i9t.u8 ing an AE 2.la.25 0 w 0 6 6ments pa4su4604o
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 40 -
3.4.3.7
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
The Pause, Resume and Abort functions are provided on the Acquisition/Replay Icon toolbar as shown in figure 59.
The icons are fashioned after similar visual controls used in the Audio tape recorder business. To pause your test,
simply press the Acquisition/Replay icon labeled Pause. In pause you can see the test status box change to Test
Paused. You can also see the Time of Test clock stop. At this point, the system will stop collecting AE data, will
flush all buffers to disk, but the test will not be exited and the AE data file will remain open. Someone might want to
Pause during a test to ignore some event that might add noise to the test (such as pressure or loading ramp -ups, etc.).
To resume, just press the Resume icon button located next to the Pause button. This restarts acquisition and the Time
of Test clock starts back up again showing the new and current time, taking into account the pause time. To Abort the
test, simply click the button labeled Abort (see figure 59). Selecting this function stops the test and saves only the data
to the data file that already exists on disk. The only difference between the Abort and the standard exiting of a an AE
test is that the buffer contents are ignored in the case of an abort while ALL data is saved and written to the AE data file
in a normal test exit. This function was mainly implemented for SPARTAN products as it could take the ICCs many
seconds (when AE data rates were high) to empty their buffers. The abort function was convenient in those cases
where the user wanted to quickly stop a trial test without waiting for data in the buffers to clear. The abort function is
not needed in newer products as the transfer rates are very fast.
3.4.4
To exit data acquisition, first Pause the test by pressing the Pause icon button (see figure 59). Then stop the test by
pressing the Abort/Stop key (the Abort/Stop key becomes a STOP function key, whenever the system is in Pause).
Upon receiving the Pause, all buffers are flushed to disk and upon receiving the Stop, the AE data file is closed and
AEwin exits acquisition. The Status box (lower center of screen) indicates IDLE meaning that AEwin is ready to
perform another test or a replay.
If you have made any setup changes before, during or after acquisition and you want to update the .LAY (layout) file
(which you should), you may do so by going to the file menu and choosing Save Layout... or Save Layout as menu
item. Save Layout will overwrite your existing layout file with the new information, while Save Layout as will
allow you to rename the layout file as a new file. Then you can follow the guidelines to save the new .LAY file. Enter
a name such as TEST1.LAY. It is not recommended to overwrite the existing Layout.LAY file since you may always
want to keep this default layout file in case of problems in the future. As computer experience dictates, you should
always save your work before carrying out a new task such as acquisition in case for any reason the power or computer
failny reason the power or computer
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 45 -
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
the past but now we refer to it as Line listing mode. The line listing mode allows the user to monitor any and all
types of messages being processed by the AE instrumentation. The information is in a line by line text format
listing offering an additional monitoring capability over the graphing of AE data. With Line listing mode, the user
can watch messages related to AE Hits, Events, Time driven data (parametrics), comments, Auto Sensor Test (AST),
waveforms and administrative messages. Watching the line listing scroll by, shows how the data coming in is being
processed, giving the user an idea as to the AE activity and severity. In AEwin, the Line listing has been improved
with the following features over the capabilities found in our other legacy software programs:
the ability to scroll the line listing up or down (used to only scroll down),
the ability to select which data can be shown on the line listing
flexible display of the line listing with the AE graphs, the line listing can be adjusted to take up a small
part of the screen, operate within a floating textbox or take up the entire screen.
These features do add some extra utility to the line dump listing that makes it even more important and useful in AE
testing. The rest of this section explains how to use these capabilities in AEwin.
The line listing mode can be used in acquisition or replay, and offer the same flexibility in both, however, it is
recommended to use this mode sparingly in acquisition as its use might slow down the data acquisition speed by a
significant amount. It is therefore recommended to use this when data acquisition rates are low, before a test as a
prescreening method or after a test in replay.
The line listing mode color-codes the messages in order to make them easier to spot as they are scrolling by. Please
note the following message types and colors as identified below.
Line Listing Message Type
AE hit data
AE Event data
AE waveforms
Time Driven Data (e.g. Parametrics, ASL, RMS, etc.)
Administrative messages (Pause, Resume, Alarm, etc.)
3.6.1
In normal use, AEwin is kept in graph mode and the line listing is not displayed (as shown in figure 59). In order to
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 47 -
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
Graphing in AEwin
The graphing capability in AEwin is very impressive, as it should be since data visualization is very important in AE
testing. AEwin is able to provide multiple graphs, multiple plots within a graph, multiple graphs on a screen (or
Page using Windows terminology), and multiple screens (Pages) full of graphs. The graph types can multidimensional (2D and 3D) graphs, multi-colored graphs and multiple graph types including: Point plot, Histograms,
Waveforms and Spectrum graphs. Graph axes can be set up to be fixed scaling (always stays at a fixed minimum
and maximum value), automatic scaling (compression or sliding scale) logarithmic or linear scaling. The graphs can
be set up to plot anything versus anything, limited only by the operators imagination.
Before getting into setting up Graphs in AEwin, it is important to define the terminology used in graphing on
AEwin. This will be used throughout the manual.
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 52 -
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
Plot: A plot is defined as a single graph within a graph (or graph window). Since a graph can be set up with
multiple graphs inside, we need to distinguish the difference between the word graph as a graph window and the fact
that there can be multiple graphs in a single graph window. We therefore call this a plot. So now we can say there
are multiple plots within a graph or graph window.
Graph: A graph is a single Window on a Screen or Page. A graph is controlled by the Graph setup menu. The
graph can have multiple plots of the same type within it, but these are all set up by a single specific graph setup
menu.
Screen or Page: A screen or Page is the graph(s) that show up in the display area of the AEwin screen. This the
area between the top and bottom tool bars (see figure 8). A screen or page has a page tab located at the bottom of
the screen to select between the screen pages.
Now that we have definitions we can provide an example. Figures 61 64 show examples of different screens. Four
are shown, Figure 61 shows what we have labeled as an activity screen. The page tab at the bottom of the screen has
been labeled Activity Screen to let the user know what types of graphs are set up on this screen page. Figure 62
shows a waveform and FFT screen page. Its tab also identifies it as Waveforms. Figure 63 shows an example of
a 3D screen page with the appropriate Screen Page tab labeling. Figure 64 shows an example of some channel by
channel line plots with an appropriate screen page tab.
In regards to graphs, figures 61 64 show multiple graphs on each screen. Figures 61, 63 and 64 shows a 4 graph
screen while figure 62 shows an 8 graph screen. There is no limit to the number of graphs that can be placed on a
screen, the only limitation is a physical one, pertaining to the readability of the graphs. As far as multiple plots on a
graph, the top two graphs of figure 61 shows graphs with multiple plots. On the top left plot there are 4 different
point plots on one graph, while in the top right graph there are two line plots.
The figures 61 64 which are provided by the example Layout4.LAY and the data file Chan24.DTA give a good
idea as to the functionality of AEwin as far as graphing is concerned. Since all the major examples for graphs and
graph setups can be found in this Layout4.LAY file, it provides an excellent reference for how to set up the
different types of graphs. Please use this example as such. The following subsections will provide information on
how to generally set up a graph and screen page.
3.8.1
The following is the step-by-step process in setting up graphs in AEwin. This assumes that you are starting from a
very simple single screen, single graph arrangement, into a multiple graph, multiple screen setup.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
Before starting, give a little thought to the number of screen pages your application will need, what the theme
will be for each screen page (for tab labeling considerations) and how many and what type of graphs you would
like on each screen. The better you plan this out, the easier and faster the graphing setup process will be. Use
as an example the theme provided (and theme tabs) in the Layout4.LAY (or Layout2.LAY on Spartan or PCI2 systems) layout file whose graphical results are shown in figures 61 64.
Find an existing Layout file that gets you partially to your goal. You can then edit that layout file to meet your
exact needs. It is always easier to start with an existing layout. You can easily copy and past graphs that have
already been setup, saving a lot of time. If this is not possible, select File New Layout which will start with
1 screen page (labeled Page 1) and one graph (a Hits versus Time graph).
Create the number of screen pages that you need by adding and deleting screen pages, then edit the Page tab
titles to the desired name or description of what that page will contain.
Create the number of graphs you need in each screen page by adding or deleting graphs.
Size your graphs as desired and tile them as desired so that they are laid out in the order that you wish.
Individually setup each graph in each graph screen to get the desired result. Enter the graph setup menu for
each graph by right clicking the mouse when it is inside the graph, then select the first pop-up menu called
Graph setup to enter the graph mode.
Once you are done setting up your graph(s), test them out in acquisition or replay to make sure they act as
expected. There will always be the need for some adjustment, you will rarely get things perfect the first time.
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 53 -
3.8.2
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
As with all Windows operations, there are various ways to add and edit Screen pages. The most convenient is by
Right-clicking your mouse on an existing page Tab, adjacent to where you want to add the page. A Page/Graph
setup menu will appear. To add a New Page after the selected page, simply select the New Page menu item. To
insert a new page before the selected page, select the Insert Page menu item. In either case, a new page and page
tab will appear. The page tab will be labeled as Page X.
There are other ways to add a page including selecting the New Page Icon from the icon toolbar (looks like a blank
page), which will always place a new page at the end of the screen page tab list. You can also go to the main menu
bar and select the Page Menu to make the New Page and Insert Page selections.
Once you have created a new page, it will be empty (no graphs). You will add the desired graphs and will label the
page tab. You may add as many graphs as you wish to the screen page.
To label the page tab simply right-click on that tab and select the Rename Page menu item. This will allow you to
enter a page name. There are no major restrictions to naming a page tab. However do not make the page tab title
too long as it might take up too much space.
There is one other screen page editing function, which allows you to remove or delete a screen page. Simply right
click on the screen page tab and select the Delete page function. The screen page and tab will immediately
disappear. If you had graphs in the screen page that you deleted, they will be deleted as well.
3.8.3
Once you have a Screen Page set up, you need to begin adding and placing graphs on it. If you know how many
graphs you want and what types they will be you can quickly add and edit the graphs. If all the graphs are to be the
same style (e.g. waveform graphs, one for each channel), you should start by adding a graph, defining it and then
copying it as many times as you need. Then you can size the graphs and create the layout (position of the graphs) as
desired and then you can edit the graph setup to finalize the graph function. If each graph is to be different, you can
either copy similar graphs and paste them into the new screen page or you can simply add as many graphs as you
want on the screen and edit the graph setup for each graph added.
To add a graph to the graph screen, simply right-click you mouse anywhere in the screen page and select the New
Graph menu item. Alternatively you can left-click the new graph icon from the icon toolbar menu. This icon
shows 3 staggered graphs. Additionally you can add a new graph by selecting the Graphing New Graph main
menu selection. Whichever way you select a new graph, a single graph will appear. To add multiple graphs on the
screen, simply perform this function multiple times.
Once you have selected the number of graphs you want on the screen, you need to tile them. Tiling allows you to
place them next to each other so that each part of every graph can be seen. There are two tiling options. You can
use Tile Horizontal or Tile Vertical. The most convenient way to perform this function is to select one of these
functions from the icon tool bar. The Tile Horizontal icon is shown as two graphs stacked on top of one another
while the Tile Vertical icon shows two graphs side by side. Alternatively you can select these from the Window
main menu. Tile Horizontal will favor a length-wise positioning of the graphs and will usually make the graphs
longer than taller. Tile Vertical will give preference to a vertical direction. Choose one of these to place the graphs
in a nice ordered manner.
Once the graphs are placed on the screen, we can alter their sizes. We do this using the standard Windows
conventions of moving the mouse to the edge of a graph until we see a double arrow and then left-click the mouse
and move the edge in or out to make the graph larger or smaller. We can also move graphs by right-clicking on the
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 54 -
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
graph and selecting the Move Graph menu item. An example of sizing graphs can be seen in figure 63 where we
have sized the 3D graph to be larger than the associated graphs.
The final function that we need to perform is that of editing or setting up the graphs to perform the desired display
function.
3.8.4
This section discusses the graph setup menu and how to set up a graph. First, we select the graph that we want to
modify. We do this by right clicking the mouse when it is inside the graph region of the graph that we want to work
on. Once we do that a menu appears. This menu gives us many choices but we will select the top one called Graph
Setup. Upon selecting this a graph setup menu appears like that shown to the right.
This shows us how we have setup the Graph
setup menu for a Hits versus Time graph. It
gives us a lot of insight into how the graph
setup menu works and how to set it up. Lets
note first the layout of the menu. We see at
the top of the menu, a selection area for
Channels, Event Groups, Clustering, Misc and
Alarms. These settings allow us to configure
those items. When in the Channels Tab, we
can select which channels and/or channel
groups will be displayed on the graph that we
are setting up. In this case we are selecting all
active channels for viewing in the graph. You
can see that we have no groups set up in Event
Groups if you select that tab. Clustering
allows you to set up parameters that link
closely spaced hits/events together for point
plot graphs. Misc allows you to set various
options like turning on/off the legend control.
Alarms allow you to create and customize
graph alarms on this graph.
Figure 72. Graph Setup Menu for Hits versus Time Graph
The next menu area is the Graph Type selection box. This is located just below the Channel, Event Group and
Clustering selection area. Various graph types can be selected included 2D Histograms, 2D Scatter (Point Plots), 3D
Histograms, waveforms, Power Spectrum plots, etc. With the selection of the graph type the graph setup menu below
this may change to offer the special configurations needed by that graph type. For the hits versus time application we
will use the 2D Histogram.
Below the Graph Type selection, is the Y-Axis setup menu area. Going down one item at a time in this menu is the
Plot # selection within the graph. This selection allows you to select more than one plot to be graphed. The one being
selected for setup is the one shown. We have only selected one plot in this graph called the Primary.
Next is the Y- Axis parameter to be plotted on the graph. By clicking this, you can see many selections. However, we
have selected Hits. This will display the number of hits (on all channels) detected, on the Y-Axis.
The checkbox One per Channel allows us to select a unique per channel plotting color that will give us a multiple
color by channel plot. In our case for hits and all active channels, if we selected this checkbox, we will get a multiple
plot graph, each plot a different color based on the hits from that one channel, up to 6 plots on one graph. If not
checked, we will only get one color plot.
The next two edit boxes allow us to set the starting Y-axis settings (minimum and maximum).
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 55 -
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
Execution
Notes
A Cluster/Area History process can be started at any time during or after a test that has autodump ON or
during/after a replay. A data file MUST be present for this feature to be available.
It is important to note that the bounds of a history graph reflect the bounds of the cluster or area at the time
when the process was started. These bounds do not change if the cluster itself grows.
Cluster/Area History on event based source graphs is disabled if the Enable Event-Linking and Cluster/Area
History checkbox on the Acquire/Replay dialog is disabled before the current test or replay begins.
3.11
Graph Alarms
Graph Alarms is a feature that enables certain graph types to trigger an alarm whenever data is plotted on them
above one or two pre-set thresholds (warning and trip). They are available on 2D Histograms, 2D Scatter graphs,
Binned Scatter graphs and Colored Scatter graphs during data acquisition.
3.11.1
An Alarms tab is available in graph setup (for graph types that can use them).
1) Check the Enable Graph Alarm checkbox to turn on graph alarm functionality for this graph.
2) Check the Enable Warning checkbox to enable the alarm warning level. Check the Enable Trip checkbox
to enable the alarm trip level. Either or both may be used at the same time.
3) Set the vertical axis thresholds for the alarm levels you have enabled.
4) Select which vertical axis controls the graph alarm (Primary, Secondary-1, etc).
3.11.2
Graphs that have an enabled graph alarm will display horizontal lines at the levels of the thresholds set in graph
setup (Green for warning, Red for trip).
A graph alarm Warning will trigger when all of the following occurs.
The warning level is enabled for that graph.
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 63 -
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
New data is displayed on this graph at or above the green threshold line.
No graph alarm (Warning or Trip) is currently active (on this graph).
An alarm Trip will trigger when all of the following occurs.
The trip level is enabled for that graph.
New data is displayed on this graph at or above the red threshold line.
No graph alarm trip is currently active (on this graph).
New data is defined as any data that is plotted after the alarm was last reset. Note that the alarm is automatically
reset at the start of the test.
3.11.3
2)
3)
Tips:
Graph alarms are checked when the graphs are refreshed. If you want to increase the rate at which they are
checked then you should increase the rate at which the graphs are updated. See the settings in Display
Mode under the Test Setup menu.
Note that data does not have to be in the visible portion of the graph to trigger an alarm. Panning/Zooming of
the graph will not hinder graph alarm operation.
It is recommended that 2D Scatter (not Binned/Colored) graphs that have a graph alarm enabled use only
Manual scaling on the Y (vertical) axis. Using compression or sliding scale wont hinder graph alarm operation
but it may slide the threshold line off the visible portion of the screen.
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 64 -
3.4
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
This section is provided to help you understand the sequence of getting into and running an AE Test for the first time
using the provided Layout (.LAY) files and also gives you insight into a more detailed sequence of carrying out an AE
data acquisition test. Before starting in acquisition, you should have your AE system already set up as per the Getting
Started section of your AE system manual. This usually entails, connecting sensors, preamplifiers and cables to the
AE system, connecting up your AE system, computer keyboard, mouse and monitor and booting up your system into
AEwin as previously instructed. If you are not ready to connect up the AE system to conduct some type of AE test or
at least any AE experimental test on a laboratory test, then skip this section and proceed to the next major section on
Replaying an AE test with AEwin.
The key to carrying out an AE test is in setting up the hardware set-ups, graphics, location setups and display modes to
your particular requirements prior to entering the test. Although there are many set-up items and they might seem
conf -0.1810i9t.u8 ing an AE 2.la.25 0 w 0 6 6ments pa4su4604o
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 40 -
4.
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
LOCATION
The purpose of this section is to familiarize you with setting up and using the software location modes. Location is
the process of collecting incoming hits into events & analyzing the arrival times of the hits in an event to produce a
source location. The individual location modes have several key differences which are summarized in the table
below.
Location
Mode
Hits
Used
Zonal
Linear
Tank Bottom
2D Planar
2D Planar (xy)
2D Planar (yz)
2D Planar (xz)
3
3-8
3-8
Cylinder
3-8
Conical
Spherical
3-8
3-8
3D
Location
3D T0
Location
4-8
5-8
Description
Trivial solution to location. Identifies the sensor closest to the
source using the relative arrival times of the hits. Returns the first
hit sensor coordinates as source location.
Designed for 1 dimensional location on a line. Performs linear
interpolation between 2 sensors' coordinates based on differences in
the arrival times of the first 2 hits in the event.
Designed for analyzing 2D circular arrays of sensors.
Designed for an arbitrary array of sensors on a 2D plane.
2D Planar designed to complement 3D Location. Locates using just
2 of the 3D coordinates & ignores the 3rd. Useful for some events
that fail normal 3D Location.
2D Planar analysis wrapped around a 3D cylindrical shell. The
ends of the cylinder may be open or have flat, spherical or elliptical
endcaps. Assumes sound travel through cylinder shell rather than
its interior.
2D Planar wrapped around a 3D conical shell.
2D Planar wrapped around a 3D spherical shell again assuming
sound travel via the shell only.
2D Planar extended to 3D coordinates assuming sound travel
directly through space rather than via an external shell.
3D Location with time zero input. Assumes all events are signaled
via one channel that accurately indicates the absolute start time of
an event.
Analysis
Type
Required
Option
Single
Standard
Single
Standard
Single
Regression
Tank Bottom
Full
Regression
3D
Regression
Full
Regression
Regression
Full
Spherical
Regression
Regression
3D
Location
3D T0
Location
The most important difference in the location modes is the geometry they are designed for. The geometry in turn
affects the number of hits used per event to calculate the location. The type of analysis also affects the number of
hits used in an event. The single analysis modes use just enough hits to create one set of simultaneous equations
which are then solved to extract the source location coordinates. A more complex approach uses more hits &
multiple regression analysis to produce the source location that best fits all the available data. By using data from
extra sensors, the regression modes yield a more accurate source location with improved immunity to errors in the
individual arrival times. For more details, see the section 4.1, Theoretical Background.
Two location modes, zonal & linear, are standard features. Others are location enhancements that require additional
licensing options. If you are not sure what locations options are enabled in your software, look for the Options
dialog available on the Help pulldown menu. It will show a checkmark next to any purchased options. If you wish
to purchase additional license options for other location modes, contact Physical Acoustics Corp. at 1-609-716-4000.
4.1
Theoretical Background
The following section provides a brief overview of the math behind location. It is definitely not required that the
average user to comprehend this material. It's purpose is to educate the inquisitive & allow the user additional
insight into what location is doing behind the scenes.
The fundamental basis for the location calculation is just the simple time-distance relationship implied by the
velocity of the sound wave. The absolute arrival time, t, of a hit in an event can combine with the velocity, v, of the
sound wave to yield the distance, d, from the sensor to the source.
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 66 -
Rev. 1.90
d = v*t
Chapter IV
(1)
The distance between 2 points depends on the geometry of the problem. The majority of the location modes are a
variation of 2 dimensional source location in a plane, although in many cases the 2D plane will wrap around a 3
dimensional object. For 2 points in a flat plane, the distance equation is just the Pythagorean theorem expressed in
Cartesian coordinates:
d = ( x2 x1 ) 2 + ( y2 y1 ) 2
(2)
This calculation is complicated by the lack of knowledge of the exact time the event originated. To get around that
problem, all the times are considered relative to the first hit in the event. Each arrival time difference implies a
difference in distance to the sensor relative to the distance to the first hit sensor. For the second hit sensor relative to
the first hit sensor, a difference equation can be written as:
t2 t1 = ( d 2 d1 ) / v
(3)
The distance equation (2) can be combined with the difference equation (3) to yield:
t 2 t1 = [ ( x2 x S ) 2 + ( y 2 y S ) 2 ( x1 x S ) 2 + ( y1 y S ) 2 ] / v
(4)
where xS & yS are the unknown coordinates of the source. This equation contains 2 unknowns & cannot be solved
by itself. To get a second equation with the same 2 unknowns, a 3rd hit is added to the event producing analogous
equation:
t 3 t1 = [ ( x3 x S ) 2 + ( y3 y S ) 2 ( x1 xS ) 2 + ( y1 y S ) 2 ] / v
(5)
These simultaneous equations can then be solved for xS & yS, although the algebra is fairly comp lex. Tank Bottom
location uses this particular approach to produce a source location from 3 hits as did the original version of 2D
Planar location before it was extended to include multiple regression analysis.
If there are additional hits added to the event, there is a question of how to use the extra information. In the case of
Tank Bottom location, the algorithm simply takes the extra hits & tries them 3 at a time to produce extra source
locations. It iterates through all the 3 hit combinations of the hits in the event until it exhausts them or runs into a
user specified maximum. The problem with this approach is that it produces more than one source location per
event & if there is any error in the timing values, the source location can be wildly incorrect. A better approach
would be to average the data somehow to produce a single location.
Multiple regression analysis does just that, although it does not actually average the results of multiple 3 hit
calculations directly. Rather it searches for the location that best fits all the all the available data. Each additional
hit basically adds an extra equation to the set of simultaneous equations given above as (4) & (5). This can be
generalized as:
t i t1 = [ ( xi x S ) 2 + ( yi y S ) 2 ( x1 x S ) 2 + ( y1 y S ) 2 ] / v
(6)
If one defines
t i = t i t1
(7)
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 67 -
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
t i = [ ( xi x S ) 2 + ( y i y S ) 2 ( x1 x S ) 2 + ( y1 y S ) 2 ] / v
(8)
Equations (7) & (8) give 2 ways of calculating the t of the ith sensor. Using the known arrival times of the hits,
equation (7) calculates the observed time difference, ti,obs,. For a given set of source location coordinates, equation
(8) defines the calculated time difference, ti,calc. Multiple regression analysis is a general purpose algorithm that
minimizes the difference between 2 quantities which in this case are the observed & calculated t values. To do that
2
a quantity called (chi square) is calculated. In our case, it is defined as a sum across all sensors in the event:
2 = ( t i ,obs t i, calc) 2
(9)
This quantity is also called the fit value and is dependent on the x,y coordinates of the source location . The sum is
2
recalculated for each potential source location. Assuming no error in the data, will have a value of 0 at the
2
source location. The location code searches for the values of xS & yS that minimize the value of . The process is
an iterative search, because it is not possible to directly write down simple equations for the values of xS & y S that
2
minimize .
The search is performed using one of 2 algorithms, either a Simplex search (3D or 2D Planar modes) or Powell's
Method (Spherical, Cylinder & Conical Location). Both search methods are based in general on code & algorithms
described in Numerical Recipes in C, 2nd edition (NRC). The code has obviously been heavily adapted for the
problem of acoustic emission source location, so there are significant variations from the NRC originals. The
interested user may, however, find more information about Simplex & Powell fitting & searching in NRC in chapter
10 & more information on regression analysis in chapter 15.
The math gets more complicated when extended to 3 dimensions or involves wrapping around a 3D object, but the
approach is still basically the same. An important point is that the regression approach is no longer over determined
in the case of the event containing the minimum number of hits, i.e. 3 hits for 2D Planar. In that case, however,
regression analysis turns out to be mathematically equivalent to solving the complicated algebra of equations (4) &
(5) & yields the same location coordinates.
4.2
When setting up location groups, you use the Location Setup dialog box (F8 shortcut key). It has 2 tabs labeled
General and Timing. Source locations are produced by analyzing events. Events are just collections of hits & their
associated time of arrival. The settings on the General page control how hits are combined into events & how events
are analyzed by the location modes to produce source locations. The settings on the Timing page control how the
time of arrival of each individual hit is determined and even whether or not a hit is considered significant or
excluded from the location analysis.
You should be aware of the F5 function key. It allows the user to quickly set all rows in a column of the grid to the
value of the current cell. It works on both the General & the Timing tabs. In the example setup shown below,
pressing F5 would set all rows of the Overcal column to the current cell's value of 200.
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 68 -
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
The layout for the General tab is shown above. The grid on the General page of Location Setup contains a list of
location groups & their type. If you click an entry in the Location Type column, an arrow appears allowing you to
change the type. As mentioned above, many location types (3D, Spherical, Cylinder) appear only if you have
purchased the appropriate option.
Group #: This column acts as an On/Off setting. Unchecked groups are ignored when doing a replay.
Show All Points: This column allows the user to show all source results for events that this group can successfully
locate. Independent of which groups have Show All Points checked, the software always allows all enabled groups
to analyze a given event to get the best results for each group and then compares the results from all successful
groups to come up with a best result. For example, linear location is always presumed to give a better result that
zonal location, if there are enough hits(2) to produce a location. If no groups have Show All Points checked, the
software will report one source location per event & it is the best result that is shown on graphs & in the line display.
There are times when a side-by-side comparison of the results of 2 locations groups are useful. In that case you can
mark the groups as Show All Points & then whatever source locations they can calculate will be reported. The
software will appear to sometimes produce more than one source location per event & if you look at the line display,
you will see extra event listings with the same first hit times. The extra location results will also show up as extra
points on your graphs too, but they only count as 1 event in the Statistics bar. In all cases you will see the software's
best result as one of the points. There will be times when an event cannot be located by more than 1 group, so
having Show All Points does not guarantee a result from a given location group. It is only a guarantee that you will
see it, if it can produce a useful result.
Location Type: The Location Type column lets you specify which location mode to use with this particular
location group. If you click on a cell in this column, a down arrow appears on the right hand side of the cell. If you
click the down arrow, a drop down list of the available location choices will appear. The available choices do
depend on the software licensing options as mentioned in the introduction, so you may not see all the location modes
that are discussed in this manual.
Wave Velocity: The Wave Velocity is the expected rate of propagation of the acoustic emission signal you wish to
monitor. It is entered in the users Distance Units per sec. For example, if the Distance Units are in Inches, then the
Wave Velocity takes units of Inches/sec. If the user's Distance Units are time based, this column is ignored by the
location algorithm. The Materials button will allow you to access a database of known velocities for various
materials. See the section on the Material Properties dialog for more information. It is always recommended that
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 69 -
3.4.3.7
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
The Pause, Resume and Abort functions are provided on the Acquisition/Replay Icon toolbar as shown in figure 59.
The icons are fashioned after similar visual controls used in the Audio tape recorder business. To pause your test,
simply press the Acquisition/Replay icon labeled Pause. In pause you can see the test status box change to Test
Paused. You can also see the Time of Test clock stop. At this point, the system will stop collecting AE data, will
flush all buffers to disk, but the test will not be exited and the AE data file will remain open. Someone might want to
Pause during a test to ignore some event that might add noise to the test (such as pressure or loading ramp -ups, etc.).
To resume, just press the Resume icon button located next to the Pause button. This restarts acquisition and the Time
of Test clock starts back up again showing the new and current time, taking into account the pause time. To Abort the
test, simply click the button labeled Abort (see figure 59). Selecting this function stops the test and saves only the data
to the data file that already exists on disk. The only difference between the Abort and the standard exiting of a an AE
test is that the buffer contents are ignored in the case of an abort while ALL data is saved and written to the AE data file
in a normal test exit. This function was mainly implemented for SPARTAN products as it could take the ICCs many
seconds (when AE data rates were high) to empty their buffers. The abort function was convenient in those cases
where the user wanted to quickly stop a trial test without waiting for data in the buffers to clear. The abort function is
not needed in newer products as the transfer rates are very fast.
3.4.4
To exit data acquisition, first Pause the test by pressing the Pause icon button (see figure 59). Then stop the test by
pressing the Abort/Stop key (the Abort/Stop key becomes a STOP function key, whenever the system is in Pause).
Upon receiving the Pause, all buffers are flushed to disk and upon receiving the Stop, the AE data file is closed and
AEwin exits acquisition. The Status box (lower center of screen) indicates IDLE meaning that AEwin is ready to
perform another test or a replay.
If you have made any setup changes before, during or after acquisition and you want to update the .LAY (layout) file
(which you should), you may do so by going to the file menu and choosing Save Layout... or Save Layout as menu
item. Save Layout will overwrite your existing layout file with the new information, while Save Layout as will
allow you to rename the layout file as a new file. Then you can follow the guidelines to save the new .LAY file. Enter
a name such as TEST1.LAY. It is not recommended to overwrite the existing Layout.LAY file since you may always
want to keep this default layout file in case of problems in the future. As computer experience dictates, you should
always save your work before carrying out a new task such as acquisition in case for any reason the power or computer
failny reason the power or computer
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 45 -
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
When the Location Type is not set to an regression mode, the Max Iteration column & the Hits/Event Min & Max
columns will be disabled. In that case the Max Iterations column displays 0 as iterations are not used for the other
modes. The Hits/Event Min & Max settings will be updated with the number of hits required for the location mode.
For example, the Linear location mode requires 2 hits to produce a location and if Location Type is set to Linear,
Hits/Event Min & Max will both display 2 & the user will not be able to adjust the setting.
4.2.2
Timing strategies processes hits and their accompanying waveform to produce a time of arrival. A list of arrival
times a series of hits is grouped together to form an event. The location modes analyze the arrival time differences
(delta t's) in the event to calculate the source location. For an enabled location mode, the software always analyzes
the event at least once. The first analysis is performed using only the arrival times from the Primary Strategy. If
you use additional strategies with one of the regression modes, the software performs a second event analysis to
refine the source location by adding the arrival times produced by the secondary strategies (1-4) to the event.
The settings for the strategy are on the Timing page, but you control which location groups use them with the
Timing Strategies column on the General page. When you click on a cell in the Timing Strategies column, the
Select Strategies dialog appears as shown below.
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 71 -
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
the past but now we refer to it as Line listing mode. The line listing mode allows the user to monitor any and all
types of messages being processed by the AE instrumentation. The information is in a line by line text format
listing offering an additional monitoring capability over the graphing of AE data. With Line listing mode, the user
can watch messages related to AE Hits, Events, Time driven data (parametrics), comments, Auto Sensor Test (AST),
waveforms and administrative messages. Watching the line listing scroll by, shows how the data coming in is being
processed, giving the user an idea as to the AE activity and severity. In AEwin, the Line listing has been improved
with the following features over the capabilities found in our other legacy software programs:
the ability to scroll the line listing up or down (used to only scroll down),
the ability to select which data can be shown on the line listing
flexible display of the line listing with the AE graphs, the line listing can be adjusted to take up a small
part of the screen, operate within a floating textbox or take up the entire screen.
These features do add some extra utility to the line dump listing that makes it even more important and useful in AE
testing. The rest of this section explains how to use these capabilities in AEwin.
The line listing mode can be used in acquisition or replay, and offer the same flexibility in both, however, it is
recommended to use this mode sparingly in acquisition as its use might slow down the data acquisition speed by a
significant amount. It is therefore recommended to use this when data acquisition rates are low, before a test as a
prescreening method or after a test in replay.
The line listing mode color-codes the messages in order to make them easier to spot as they are scrolling by. Please
note the following message types and colors as identified below.
Line Listing Message Type
AE hit data
AE Event data
AE waveforms
Time Driven Data (e.g. Parametrics, ASL, RMS, etc.)
Administrative messages (Pause, Resume, Alarm, etc.)
3.6.1
In normal use, AEwin is kept in graph mode and the line listing is not displayed (as shown in figure 59). In order to
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 47 -
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
Derive from Waveform: The Derive From Waveform checkbox controls whether the strategy attempts to extract
the arrival time from the waveform. If it is disabled (unchecked), the arrival time can still vary from that produced
by the Primary Strategy if the Timing Feature for the secondary strategy varies from the Primary Timing Feature
setting.
Enable Filter: The Enable Filter checkbox controls whether a digital is applied to the waveform before the arrival
time is determined.
Evaluation Threshold: The Evaluation Threshold is similar to the Hardware Setup Threshold used during data
acquisition. If the Timing Feature is set to FTC (First Threshold Crossing), the Threshold directly impacts the
arrival time or even whether an arrival is detected. The Evaluation Threshold is applied to the waveform after the
optional digital filter is applied. Note that the Hardware Setup Threshold affects what data is recorded during
acquisition. The user can set the Evaluation Threshold to values higher than the Hardware Setup Threshold used
during data acquisition & simulate the results that would have been recorded during acquisition with a higher
Threshold. Beware, though, setting it to lower values cannot reveal data that was not recorded in the first place.
Upper & Lower Frequency: Lower Frequency & Upper Frequency columns control the bandpass cutoff
frequencies. Turning on the digital filter & adjusting the filter cutoff frequencies can help isolate individual acoustic
emission modes with differing wave velocities. Note that you should be aware of the sampling rate used during
acquisition and avoid setting the Lower Frequency cutoff above the lowest sampling rate on any channel. You
should also avoid targeting frequency ranges that your sensors do not respond to or that have been removed by your
hardware's analog filters. Otherwise you could be analyzing meaningless waveforms.
4.2.3
Pressing the Distance Units button opens the Distance Units dialog
box. The user can select his desired units from the dropdown list.
The user is given an option of converting old numerical values to the
new units by simply checking the "Convert all numerical values
based on new units." option. This will cause the event definition
value, event lockout value, the overcal settings, the wave velocities
& sensor positions to be updated as appropriate.
Figure 82. Distance Units
4.2.4
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 73 -
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
4.2.5
Attenuation Dialog
Pressing the Attenuation button opens the Attenuation dialog box shown below. The sole purpose of this dialog is
to allow the software to account for the decay of the acoustic emmission as a function of distance travelled & to
estimate of the initial amplitude at the source. It uses the amplitude observed at the first hit sensor, the distance to
the source for the event and the attenuation table entered by the user in this dialog. The attenuation table documents
amplitude as a function of distance. The units of distance are controlled by the Location Setup Distance Units
setting. The Update button will causes the graph to display the current values in the table. The user may use the
Save & Recall buttons to save or recall an attenuation table to/from the disk
The basic procedure uses the table to calculate the difference
between an amplitude at the source & at the observed distance
from the source. If the source to first hit sensor dis tance falls
within the range of values in the table, an amplitude at that
distance is calculated using linear interpolation between the 2
nearest distances in the table. Using the table above as an
example, if the source was determined to be 2.5 feet from the
first hit sensor, the table has the 2 closest entries as 68 at 2.0
feet & 62 at 3.0. The amplitude predicted at 2.5 feet would be
65 (= 68 (68-62)*0.5).
The correction applied to the
amplitude at the first hit sensor would be 25 dB (= 90 - 65). If
the first hit amplitude was 60, the line display would report a
Source Amplitude of 85 for this example. The amplitudes are
not extrapolated beyond the maximum distance. If the distance
is beyond the maximum distance in the table, only the
maximum correction of 46 (= 90 44) is applied. If the user
never accesses this dialog to fill in the table, no correction is
applied & the source amplitude reported is identical to the
amplitude of the first hit sensor.
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 74 -
4.2.6
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
Pressing this button opens the Guard Sensors dialog box. Guard Sensors can be used to lockout out events on
selected location groups whenever a hit is first detected on a guard channel. It is designed for situations in which
one wishes to ignore events that originate outside of the location group.
In the example setup shown, sensors 1, 3 & 5 are protecting Location Group 1 from outside events. If there is a hit
on sensors 1, 3 or 5, then Location Group 1 will not process any events for the next 1000 us. If the Event Only flag
were checked, only the next event on Location Group 1 would be locked out instead of being locked out for the next
1000us. The Lockout Time field would also be disabled as it's value would no longer be used.
The Guard Data Filter Setup controls what hits get saved into the DTA file during acquisition, if guard sensors are
enabled. The default setting is to just save all hits, but you can restrict the data saved to just those hits that make up
events & the guard sensor hits. This can be useful in situations where external noise creates a large number of hits
that end up being useless for the purpose of location. Not only do the extra hits take up space in the data file, but
they also slow down replays of the data file too.
4.3
Before discussing the Sensor Placement Dialog, there is one important point about the physical placement of your
sensors that you should understand and it applies to all of the regression location modes. You can place sensors
anywhere, but you will get better results with the regression location modes if your sensor layout is made up of an
evenly spaced triangular array of sensors. The optimal arrangement would be a triangular grid made up of
equilateral triangles, but the regression modes do not require exact equality of the triangle legs or even regular
spacing between the sensors. Avoid creating triangles with one very long or very short side, however, as they do
not work well for locating sources.
Pressing the Location View button in the Location Setup
dialog opens the Sensor Placement dialog box. shown here.
The 2 main areas are the actual view of the sensors in the
left-hand side of the dialog & a listing of their coordinates in
the right-hand side. The grid area for the sensor coordinates
also has tabs that will display the coordinates of any welds
and nozzles created. You can change the color of the sensors
using the Graphing menu to access Sensor Color on the
Colors submenu.
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 75 -
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
The Structure list is just below the grid area. Support for welds, nozzles, manual
placement of sensors & autoplacement of sensors varies with the Structure setting.
When creating a sensor layout for a new location group, the first thing you should do in
the Sensor Placement dialog is to set the Structure list. The Group # setting allows you
to quickly switch to editing the sensors for another location group without having to
return to the Location Setup dialog. If you made changes to the current settings, you
are prompted to save them.
Below the Structure setting is the Dimension button. If you click it, one
of the dimensions dialogs will appear. They are also specific to the type
of Structure. The one shown to the right is for the Plate structure. When
working with a new location group, the second thing you should do in
Sensor Placement is to fill in the dimensions for the structure you are
working with. The dimensions affect the scaling of the sensor view
area. If you have incorrect values entered, some sensors may not be
visible in the sensor view.
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 76 -
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
Graphing in AEwin
The graphing capability in AEwin is very impressive, as it should be since data visualization is very important in AE
testing. AEwin is able to provide multiple graphs, multiple plots within a graph, multiple graphs on a screen (or
Page using Windows terminology), and multiple screens (Pages) full of graphs. The graph types can multidimensional (2D and 3D) graphs, multi-colored graphs and multiple graph types including: Point plot, Histograms,
Waveforms and Spectrum graphs. Graph axes can be set up to be fixed scaling (always stays at a fixed minimum
and maximum value), automatic scaling (compression or sliding scale) logarithmic or linear scaling. The graphs can
be set up to plot anything versus anything, limited only by the operators imagination.
Before getting into setting up Graphs in AEwin, it is important to define the terminology used in graphing on
AEwin. This will be used throughout the manual.
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 52 -
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
Plot: A plot is defined as a single graph within a graph (or graph window). Since a graph can be set up with
multiple graphs inside, we need to distinguish the difference between the word graph as a graph window and the fact
that there can be multiple graphs in a single graph window. We therefore call this a plot. So now we can say there
are multiple plots within a graph or graph window.
Graph: A graph is a single Window on a Screen or Page. A graph is controlled by the Graph setup menu. The
graph can have multiple plots of the same type within it, but these are all set up by a single specific graph setup
menu.
Screen or Page: A screen or Page is the graph(s) that show up in the display area of the AEwin screen. This the
area between the top and bottom tool bars (see figure 8). A screen or page has a page tab located at the bottom of
the screen to select between the screen pages.
Now that we have definitions we can provide an example. Figures 61 64 show examples of different screens. Four
are shown, Figure 61 shows what we have labeled as an activity screen. The page tab at the bottom of the screen has
been labeled Activity Screen to let the user know what types of graphs are set up on this screen page. Figure 62
shows a waveform and FFT screen page. Its tab also identifies it as Waveforms. Figure 63 shows an example of
a 3D screen page with the appropriate Screen Page tab labeling. Figure 64 shows an example of some channel by
channel line plots with an appropriate screen page tab.
In regards to graphs, figures 61 64 show multiple graphs on each screen. Figures 61, 63 and 64 shows a 4 graph
screen while figure 62 shows an 8 graph screen. There is no limit to the number of graphs that can be placed on a
screen, the only limitation is a physical one, pertaining to the readability of the graphs. As far as multiple plots on a
graph, the top two graphs of figure 61 shows graphs with multiple plots. On the top left plot there are 4 different
point plots on one graph, while in the top right graph there are two line plots.
The figures 61 64 which are provided by the example Layout4.LAY and the data file Chan24.DTA give a good
idea as to the functionality of AEwin as far as graphing is concerned. Since all the major examples for graphs and
graph setups can be found in this Layout4.LAY file, it provides an excellent reference for how to set up the
different types of graphs. Please use this example as such. The following subsections will provide information on
how to generally set up a graph and screen page.
3.8.1
The following is the step-by-step process in setting up graphs in AEwin. This assumes that you are starting from a
very simple single screen, single graph arrangement, into a multiple graph, multiple screen setup.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
Before starting, give a little thought to the number of screen pages your application will need, what the theme
will be for each screen page (for tab labeling considerations) and how many and what type of graphs you would
like on each screen. The better you plan this out, the easier and faster the graphing setup process will be. Use
as an example the theme provided (and theme tabs) in the Layout4.LAY (or Layout2.LAY on Spartan or PCI2 systems) layout file whose graphical results are shown in figures 61 64.
Find an existing Layout file that gets you partially to your goal. You can then edit that layout file to meet your
exact needs. It is always easier to start with an existing layout. You can easily copy and past graphs that have
already been setup, saving a lot of time. If this is not possible, select File New Layout which will start with
1 screen page (labeled Page 1) and one graph (a Hits versus Time graph).
Create the number of screen pages that you need by adding and deleting screen pages, then edit the Page tab
titles to the desired name or description of what that page will contain.
Create the number of graphs you need in each screen page by adding or deleting graphs.
Size your graphs as desired and tile them as desired so that they are laid out in the order that you wish.
Individually setup each graph in each graph screen to get the desired result. Enter the graph setup menu for
each graph by right clicking the mouse when it is inside the graph, then select the first pop-up menu called
Graph setup to enter the graph mode.
Once you are done setting up your graph(s), test them out in acquisition or replay to make sure they act as
expected. There will always be the need for some adjustment, you will rarely get things perfect the first time.
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 53 -
3.8.2
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
As with all Windows operations, there are various ways to add and edit Screen pages. The most convenient is by
Right-clicking your mouse on an existing page Tab, adjacent to where you want to add the page. A Page/Graph
setup menu will appear. To add a New Page after the selected page, simply select the New Page menu item. To
insert a new page before the selected page, select the Insert Page menu item. In either case, a new page and page
tab will appear. The page tab will be labeled as Page X.
There are other ways to add a page including selecting the New Page Icon from the icon toolbar (looks like a blank
page), which will always place a new page at the end of the screen page tab list. You can also go to the main menu
bar and select the Page Menu to make the New Page and Insert Page selections.
Once you have created a new page, it will be empty (no graphs). You will add the desired graphs and will label the
page tab. You may add as many graphs as you wish to the screen page.
To label the page tab simply right-click on that tab and select the Rename Page menu item. This will allow you to
enter a page name. There are no major restrictions to naming a page tab. However do not make the page tab title
too long as it might take up too much space.
There is one other screen page editing function, which allows you to remove or delete a screen page. Simply right
click on the screen page tab and select the Delete page function. The screen page and tab will immediately
disappear. If you had graphs in the screen page that you deleted, they will be deleted as well.
3.8.3
Once you have a Screen Page set up, you need to begin adding and placing graphs on it. If you know how many
graphs you want and what types they will be you can quickly add and edit the graphs. If all the graphs are to be the
same style (e.g. waveform graphs, one for each channel), you should start by adding a graph, defining it and then
copying it as many times as you need. Then you can size the graphs and create the layout (position of the graphs) as
desired and then you can edit the graph setup to finalize the graph function. If each graph is to be different, you can
either copy similar graphs and paste them into the new screen page or you can simply add as many graphs as you
want on the screen and edit the graph setup for each graph added.
To add a graph to the graph screen, simply right-click you mouse anywhere in the screen page and select the New
Graph menu item. Alternatively you can left-click the new graph icon from the icon toolbar menu. This icon
shows 3 staggered graphs. Additionally you can add a new graph by selecting the Graphing New Graph main
menu selection. Whichever way you select a new graph, a single graph will appear. To add multiple graphs on the
screen, simply perform this function multiple times.
Once you have selected the number of graphs you want on the screen, you need to tile them. Tiling allows you to
place them next to each other so that each part of every graph can be seen. There are two tiling options. You can
use Tile Horizontal or Tile Vertical. The most convenient way to perform this function is to select one of these
functions from the icon tool bar. The Tile Horizontal icon is shown as two graphs stacked on top of one another
while the Tile Vertical icon shows two graphs side by side. Alternatively you can select these from the Window
main menu. Tile Horizontal will favor a length-wise positioning of the graphs and will usually make the graphs
longer than taller. Tile Vertical will give preference to a vertical direction. Choose one of these to place the graphs
in a nice ordered manner.
Once the graphs are placed on the screen, we can alter their sizes. We do this using the standard Windows
conventions of moving the mouse to the edge of a graph until we see a double arrow and then left-click the mouse
and move the edge in or out to make the graph larger or smaller. We can also move graphs by right-clicking on the
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 54 -
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
graph and selecting the Move Graph menu item. An example of sizing graphs can be seen in figure 63 where we
have sized the 3D graph to be larger than the associated graphs.
The final function that we need to perform is that of editing or setting up the graphs to perform the desired display
function.
3.8.4
This section discusses the graph setup menu and how to set up a graph. First, we select the graph that we want to
modify. We do this by right clicking the mouse when it is inside the graph region of the graph that we want to work
on. Once we do that a menu appears. This menu gives us many choices but we will select the top one called Graph
Setup. Upon selecting this a graph setup menu appears like that shown to the right.
This shows us how we have setup the Graph
setup menu for a Hits versus Time graph. It
gives us a lot of insight into how the graph
setup menu works and how to set it up. Lets
note first the layout of the menu. We see at
the top of the menu, a selection area for
Channels, Event Groups, Clustering, Misc and
Alarms. These settings allow us to configure
those items. When in the Channels Tab, we
can select which channels and/or channel
groups will be displayed on the graph that we
are setting up. In this case we are selecting all
active channels for viewing in the graph. You
can see that we have no groups set up in Event
Groups if you select that tab. Clustering
allows you to set up parameters that link
closely spaced hits/events together for point
plot graphs. Misc allows you to set various
options like turning on/off the legend control.
Alarms allow you to create and customize
graph alarms on this graph.
Figure 72. Graph Setup Menu for Hits versus Time Graph
The next menu area is the Graph Type selection box. This is located just below the Channel, Event Group and
Clustering selection area. Various graph types can be selected included 2D Histograms, 2D Scatter (Point Plots), 3D
Histograms, waveforms, Power Spectrum plots, etc. With the selection of the graph type the graph setup menu below
this may change to offer the special configurations needed by that graph type. For the hits versus time application we
will use the 2D Histogram.
Below the Graph Type selection, is the Y-Axis setup menu area. Going down one item at a time in this menu is the
Plot # selection within the graph. This selection allows you to select more than one plot to be graphed. The one being
selected for setup is the one shown. We have only selected one plot in this graph called the Primary.
Next is the Y- Axis parameter to be plotted on the graph. By clicking this, you can see many selections. However, we
have selected Hits. This will display the number of hits (on all channels) detected, on the Y-Axis.
The checkbox One per Channel allows us to select a unique per channel plotting color that will give us a multiple
color by channel plot. In our case for hits and all active channels, if we selected this checkbox, we will get a multiple
plot graph, each plot a different color based on the hits from that one channel, up to 6 plots on one graph. If not
checked, we will only get one color plot.
The next two edit boxes allow us to set the starting Y-axis settings (minimum and maximum).
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 55 -
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
The next checkbox Log Scale allows us to set a log or linear graph scale.
The next 3 radio buttons are related, allowing you to select one type of graph scaling. Manual (Fixed) will force the
graph limits as set above to remain fixed. Compress will compress the graph so that the minimum graph value
remains but the maximum keeps changing as the graph limit is exceeded. And the sliding selection will allow both
the minimum and maximum limits to change or slide as data is received that is beyond the current limits.
The next box allows us to select what type of Input data we are plotting. In our case since we are plotting hit data, we
want to choose the Hit data for plotting.
Below this is a checkbox for displaying the a grid on the graph.
The next column to the right, shows the graph preview at the top and then the X-Axis settings.
The X-axis settings have similar setup boxes as were described for the Y-Axis and will not be described here. Just note
how they have been set up to display the Time parameter and that we have set up the minimum and maximum graph
values and a compression scaling so that we can see all data from the start of the test.
The last column on the right changes according to the graph type being set up. If a 3-D graph were being set up, this
would be the column for the Z-axis setting. If a Point plot were being set up, there would be no extra column as the
points do not need to be conditioned for display.
Since we have selected a graph type of 2-D Histogram, a Value and Bin Axis setting menu appears. The Value axis
sets which axis the histogram or bars will grow. For our example we are selecting the Y-Axis as the Hits will grow in
the vertical direction. We set a cumulate mode if we want the data in the histogram to build upon the previous bin or
bars.
The bin axis settings allow us to set the resolution and how the data that makes up a bin get counted in the histogram
bar (or what we call a bin). In general, the larger the number of bins, the finer the bars. If your bin axis is time you
usually want to have a very high number. If your bin axis is channels, you would like to match the number of bins and
channels. In terms of the bin display, you can choose whether you want to sum up all the data in the bin or if you want
to average the data in the bin or if you want a rate to be displayed (e.g. Hits/second). To understand, this assume that
we have a test for 100 seconds and that we have 100 bins. Each bin will contain one seconds worth of data. We can
decide to add it up and display it as a bin sum, average the amount of data received in that time period or display a
rate. In this case since the bin size is 1 second, all the numbers would be the same for this setting, but for any other
case, they would be different.
Learn more about these settings by making changes and seeing the effect.
At the bottom of the third column is a histogram setting that allows you to fill the histogram bars or keep them hollow.
Please note and try to make sense of all the selected menu settings. Although it might look complex at the start, if you
have gone through these settings, one at a time you will see that all is quite simple. Exit the graph menu by selecting
the OK button at the top right of the Graph setup menu.
By looking at the top of the graph we see its graph title of Hits vs. Time (sec) <all channels>. This summarizes what
is being displayed. First is the graph type Hits vs. Time (sec). Next we are displaying data from all channels.
Now that we are finished, we see that we have set up a Hits versus time graph and are ready to test it. Test it and make
any corrections, until you get the desired result. If we have other graphs, we set them up in a similar way, one at a time
until all the graphs are set up.
Now we are ready to proceed with a test or a replay. As a reminder, always save your Layout file before trying it out.
It is not fun to have all your work disappear because power went down or something happened to lose the layout.
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 56 -
3.9
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
Hit/Event Linking is a way to retrieve hit/waveform or event information on specified points on all types of scatter
graphs (2D Scatter, 2D Binned Scatter, 2D Color Scatter, 3D Scatter, Spherical Location, etc.). Once a
point or area is selected a dialog box is displayed showing a mini-linedisplay containing the hit or event messages
linked to that point (or all points in that area). The associated waveform(s) or power spectrum(s) (if any) are
displayed above it. Furthermore, a simple location plot is available with most location modes that displays the
location of all selected event points. The user can hide/display and customize this plot as desired.
During hit/event linking small cursors (crosshairs) are placed on all other valid 2D scatter/binned/color graphs
highlighting the selected hit or the first hit of the selected event.
Hit/Event linking can be performed at any time during or after a test that has autodump ON or a replay. A data file
MUST be present for this feature to be available. Changing location settings will disable hit/event linking until a
new test (with autodump on) or a replay is performed.
4)
5)
Procedure
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 57 -
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
3.9.2
Controls
The Data Lookup Display dialog box has a number of controls, most of which are located on a toolbar at the top of
the dialog. These are described below. As you move the mouse cursor over each toolbar button a tooltip will
popup to display the buttons name. Some of these controls are only available in event linking. Other controls are
only available if the Waveform Option is present.
Prev/Next Buttons: If there are multiple hits/events associated with the selected point(s) then you will be able to
view all of them. Use the prev/next buttons to step through them sequentially. The cursors (crosshairs) on any 2D
point plot graphs will move appropriately.
Select Button: Instead of using the Prev/Next buttons to step through a large number of hits/events, the Select
button can be used to jump to the desired hit/event by simply entering its hit/event number.
View All Hits/Events Button: You can view all selected hits or events together by clicking the View All button.
This will popup a dialog box with a large line display showing all hits or events associated with the selected point or
area. If you are working with a Hit-based graph (as opposed to an Event-based one) then you can export these hits
to a new data file by clicking Export to DTA. This cannot be done with events here. You can export events one
at a time from the main dialog box. See section 3.9.3 below.
Set Power Spectrum Width Button: Clicking this button will open a dialog box allowing you to set the power
spectrum width. You can set a specified width or accept the default.
Location Graph Setup Button: Clicking this button will open the Location Graph Setup dialog box. From here
you can customize the location graph, by selecting axis parameters, limits and autoscaling.
Reset Unexported User Changes Button: Clicking this button will reset any unexported changes you have made by
use of the time-of-arrival cursor. Once you Export the current hit/wave/event the change becomes permanent in
the exported file and cannot be reset.
Reset Axes Button: Clicking this button will allow you to reset the axes of one or more graphs. A dialog box will
be displayed for you to specify which graphs. You can also reset a waveform graph by right clicking it and selecting
Reset this graphs axes.
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 58 -
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
Select Zoom Mode Button: Clicking this button will select the Zoom mode for all graphs and clear the previously
selected mode. In Zoom mode you can use the mouse to select an area of a graph to view in greater detail. Use the
Reset Axes button to view the original graph again.
Select Pan Mode Button: Clicking this button will select the Pan mode for all graphs and clear the previously
selected mode. In Zoom mode you can use the mouse to drag the viewable window of graph to view data that is
currently beyond the graph axes limits. Use the Reset Axes button to view the original graph again.
Select Cursor Mode Button: Clicking this button will select the Select Cursor mode for all graphs and clear the
previously selected mo de. In Select Cursor mode you can use the mouse to drag the red Time of Arrival cursors
on waveform graphs forward or backward to effectively change its time of arrival. While in this mode the mini
line-display is replaced with a table showing the time of arrival for each graph. If you do this and then click the
Force Recalculation of Event button the event location will change and the new (modified) location will be
displayed on the location graph as a black X. Use the Reset Unexported User Changes button to undo these
changes (but only BEFORE you export them).
Synchronize Waveform Display Button: When this button is checked the waveforms will be displayed in the same
time reference. i.e. If the second waveform in an event has an arrival time 20 us after the first waveform then the
entire waveform will be positioned 20 us to the right so its time of arrival (red line) will be positioned at 20 us. If
the button is not checked, then all waveforms are left justified on the graphs (their time or arrivals will be positioned
at 0 us). This does not modify the waveforms in any way. It is simply a display preference.
Display Threshold Lines Button: When this button is checked, red horizontal lines appear on the waveform graphs
showing the threshold. When this button is unchecked these lines are hidden.
Display Power Spectrum(s) Button: The power spectrums can be viewed by clicking the Display Power
Spectrum(s) toolbar button. This will replace the waveform graphs with corresponding power spectrum graphs.
Click it again to return to viewing waveforms.
Show Location Graph Button: The location graph can be displayed by clicking the Show Location Graph toolbar
button. Clicking it again will hide the location graph. Note that this graph is only usable in event linking and only
when the event being viewed has more than one hit. You can customize this graph by clicking the Location Graph
Setup toolbar button.
Force Recalculation of Event Button: After changing the time of arrival of one or more waveforms in an event,
click this button to recalculate the event location. If successful, the new event will be shown in the mini line display
and the location graph will be modified to show an X at the location of the modified event. If a new event location
could not be created using the new time of arrivals then the mini line display will show a message indicating the
problem. Use the Reset Unexported User Changes button to undo these changes (but only BEFORE you export
them). Note that certain actions can automatically force a recalculation of the event. These actions include:
Changing the location timing strategy and exporting the event.
Export As (New File) Button: Clicking the Export As (New File) button allows you to create a new datafile and
export the currently selected hit/wave or event to that datafile. See section 3.9.3 for details.
Export Button: Clicking the Export button allows you to export the currently selected hit/wave or event to a
datafile. If you have already specified a datafile for export then it will use that datafile. If not then you will be
prompted to specify a new datafile name as if you had clicked the Export As (New File) button. See section 3.9.3
for details.
Exit Button: Clicking this button will close the Data Lookup Display dialog box without clearing the cursors
(crosshairs) placed on other graphs to denote the current hit (or first hit of the current event).
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 59 -
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
Exit and Clear Cursors Button: Clicking this button will close the Data Lookup Display dialog box and clear any
cursors (crosshairs) placed on other graphs to denote the current hit (or first hit of the current event).
Loc Timing Strategy Radio Buttons: The bandpass filters and timing strategies defined in the Timing page of the
Location Setup dialog box can be applied to the waveforms/events. Use the radio buttons in the Loc. Timing
Strategy section to select a strategy. The waveform/power spectrum graph(s) and the mini-line display will be
refreshed to show it after filtering. The default Primary strategy does not apply a filter. Note that the selected
strategy must have an enabled filter for a filter to be applied. See section 3.9.7 for information regarding the
Custom Arrival timing feature, which is particularly useful in this dialog box.
Scroll Buttons: The Scroll buttons (next to each graph) are used to change which waveform is displayed in a
particular graph. They allow you to scroll through the list of waveforms up or down as desired. This is
particularly useful when the selected event has more than 3 waveforms.
3.9.3
One feature available in the Data Lookup Display dialog box is the ability to export the current hit/wave or event
to a new datafile. This can be used as a powerful and flexible way of filtering data, as you can decide on a case by
case basis what to export to the new file. If you have made any changes to the time of arrival(s), then these changes
are exported as well (see section 3.9.4). To export the currently selected hit/wave or event simply click the Export
As (New File) button and enter a filename for the new datafile when prompted. After you do this the title of the
dialog box will indicate that the currently selected hit/wave or event has been exported. Subsequent exports to the
same file can be accomplished by selecting a new hit/wave or event (prev/next/select buttons) and clicking the
Export button.
For Systems that have the Moment Tensor Option: When you perform an export on a system that has the
Moment Tensor Option you will be asked if you want to export to PT files as well. This is used for moment tensor
(Sigma3D). If you arent using this then click no. See the file Waveform Event Synchronization.doc for details.
3.9.4
Another powerful feature of the Data Lookup Display dialog box is the ability to Modify a hit/waveforms time of
arrival, and (if event-linking) recalculate the event location. To do this, simply use the Select Cursor mode and use
the mouse to drag the (red) time of arrival cursor on a waveform graph to the desired point in time. As you do this
you will see the new time of arrival updated on a table in the mini line display. If you are in event linking then you
can recalculate the event location by clicking the Force Recalculation of Event button. This will recalculate the
event using the new time of arrivals. If your event has more than 3 hit/waves then you might have to use the scroll
controls to access some of the waveforms to modify.
If you export a hit/wave or event that has been modified in this manner then the changes will be saved to the new
datafile and accessible using the Custom Arrival timing feature in location (see section 3.9.7).
3.9.5
1)
2)
All settings in the Data Lookup Display dialog box are saved when the layout file is saved. This includes the
various on/off preferences (display threshold lines, show location graph, etc), location graph setup and
custom power spectrum width.
If the hit/event linking dialog box is open when a cluster/area history operation is performed then the dialog
box will be updated with its data.
3.9.6
1)
Other Features
Notes
Try loading the HE-LINK.LAY layout file and replaying HE-LINK.DTA. Hit/Event linking works well on
this example dataset.
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 60 -
2)
3)
4)
5)
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
2D Binned Scatter and 2D Colored Scatter graph types store their data in a binned grid structure much
like a Histogram (though in 2 axes). This means that each point on these graphs represents an area rather than
an absolute point. The cursor display (near the bottom right corner of the screen) shows the extent of the area
represented by the point. Hit/Event linking will locate all hit/events that fall into that area (lower bound
inclusive, upper bound exclusive).
Selected hit/events are not highlighted with crosshairs on 3D Scatter and Spherical Location graph types,
though hit/event linking can be initiated from them.
It is possible to perform hit linking on TRA datafiles even though they lack hits. In this case only the
waveforms will be displayed.
Event Linking functionality can be disabled by unchecking the Enable Event Linking checkbox in the
Acquire/Replay menu (this setting is NOT saved in the layout). Doing this may result in a modest performance
improvement in high data rate tests with large numbers of events. Once disabled it cannot be re-enabled until a
new test or replay is performed. Disabling Event Linking will not disable Hit-Linking functionality.
3.9.7
When a user-modified waveform is exported it is saved in its unmodified state to the new datafile. The usermodified TOA (time of arrival) is also saved for future use. This can be accessed through the use of the Custom
Arrival timing feature.
Before starting the replay, enter location setup. Set one of the timing strategies in the timing page of the location
setup dialog box to the Custom Arrival feature. If you want location plots to use the modified TOAs then select
this strategy in your location groups Timing Strategies. Or, you can simply set the Primary strategy to Custom
Arrival so all location groups will use it. Since Custom Arrival only works in replay, this will default to FTC
(First Threshold Crossing) during acquisition.
If you want to see the modified TOAs in hit/event linking:
When the Data Lookup Display dialog box is opened it will plot the locations and waveforms based on the currently
selected Loc Timing Strategy. Note that the dialog will remember your previous setting and use it by default the
next time it is loaded. If this strategy uses a Custom Arrival timing feature then all the locations will be plotted
using the modified TOAs. If this strategy doesnt use a Custom Arrival timing feature then all locations will be
plotted using the original TOAs.
Once the Data Lookup Display dialog box is loaded you can switch strategies through the use of the Loc Timing
Strategy radio buttons. Doing so will NOT re-plot all locations but it will re-plot the current one AND reposition
the TOA cursors on all current waveforms. You can switch back and forth between a timing strategy that uses
Custom Arrival and one that doesnt to view the difference between the two.
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 61 -
3.10
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
Cluster/Area History
Cluster History and Area History provide the ability to view detailed graphical information about AE activity in a
specified area on a 2D Scatter, Binned Scatter or Colored Scatter graph (called the source graph). This area can be
defined by selecting a cluster (Cluster History) or by designating an area manually (Area History). This information
is displayed on any number of graphs defined and designated by the user as History Graphs. These graphs remain
inactive until the user starts a Cluster or Area History process. When the user does so the software replays the data
contained in the selected cluster or area onto all history graphs. The history graphs then remain active for the
remainder of the test or replay, accepting/displaying any incoming data that would fall within the original bounds of
the cluster or area at the time the process was started. This process can be repeated any number of times during a
test or replay.
3.10.1
1)
Setup
To use Cluster History you need to create at least one cluster graph before starting the process, usually before
starting the test or replay. Area History does not require this.
3)
Create as many history graphs as desired. This can be done at any time before
you start the history process. Any graph can be designated as a History
Graph by checking the History Graph (Area or Cluster) checkbox on the
Misc page of graph setup. The graphs title will then include the (Hst) tag.
Start an acquisition test (with autodump on) or a replay.
3.10.2
Cluster History is started by right clicking on a cluster graph and selecting cluster
history from the menu that pops up. If this option is grayed out then it means one
of the following:
1)
2)
3)
4)
If there are more than one cluster available on the selected cluster graph then the program will prompt the user to
select one from a list.
3.10.3
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 62 -
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
Execution
Notes
A Cluster/Area History process can be started at any time during or after a test that has autodump ON or
during/after a replay. A data file MUST be present for this feature to be available.
It is important to note that the bounds of a history graph reflect the bounds of the cluster or area at the time
when the process was started. These bounds do not change if the cluster itself grows.
Cluster/Area History on event based source graphs is disabled if the Enable Event-Linking and Cluster/Area
History checkbox on the Acquire/Replay dialog is disabled before the current test or replay begins.
3.11
Graph Alarms
Graph Alarms is a feature that enables certain graph types to trigger an alarm whenever data is plotted on them
above one or two pre-set thresholds (warning and trip). They are available on 2D Histograms, 2D Scatter graphs,
Binned Scatter graphs and Colored Scatter graphs during data acquisition.
3.11.1
An Alarms tab is available in graph setup (for graph types that can use them).
1) Check the Enable Graph Alarm checkbox to turn on graph alarm functionality for this graph.
2) Check the Enable Warning checkbox to enable the alarm warning level. Check the Enable Trip checkbox
to enable the alarm trip level. Either or both may be used at the same time.
3) Set the vertical axis thresholds for the alarm levels you have enabled.
4) Select which vertical axis controls the graph alarm (Primary, Secondary-1, etc).
3.11.2
Graphs that have an enabled graph alarm will display horizontal lines at the levels of the thresholds set in graph
setup (Green for warning, Red for trip).
A graph alarm Warning will trigger when all of the following occurs.
The warning level is enabled for that graph.
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 63 -
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
New data is displayed on this graph at or above the green threshold line.
No graph alarm (Warning or Trip) is currently active (on this graph).
An alarm Trip will trigger when all of the following occurs.
The trip level is enabled for that graph.
New data is displayed on this graph at or above the red threshold line.
No graph alarm trip is currently active (on this graph).
New data is defined as any data that is plotted after the alarm was last reset. Note that the alarm is automatically
reset at the start of the test.
3.11.3
2)
3)
Tips:
Graph alarms are checked when the graphs are refreshed. If you want to increase the rate at which they are
checked then you should increase the rate at which the graphs are updated. See the settings in Display
Mode under the Test Setup menu.
Note that data does not have to be in the visible portion of the graph to trigger an alarm. Panning/Zooming of
the graph will not hinder graph alarm operation.
It is recommended that 2D Scatter (not Binned/Colored) graphs that have a graph alarm enabled use only
Manual scaling on the Y (vertical) axis. Using compression or sliding scale wont hinder graph alarm operation
but it may slide the threshold line off the visible portion of the screen.
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 64 -
3.12
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
The following is a list and short description of all the shortcut keys available in the software. Many of the shortcut
keys follow in the tradition of PACs DAQ and LOC software programs and should be familiar. Others follow
standard WINDOWS conventions. Menu items usually do list the shortcut key, but the full list is provided below
for convenience.
F1
Shift + F1
F2
F3
F4
Ctrl + F4
Shift + F4
F5
F6
Ctrl + F6
Shift + F6
F7
F8
F9
Shift + F9
F10
F11
F12
Help Menu
Context Sensitive Help
Hardware Setup
Graph Setup
Ctrl + C
Ctrl + D
Ctrl + H
Ctrl + N
Ctrl + O
Ctrl + P
Ctrl + S
Ctrl + T
Ctrl + V
Ctrl + X
Ctrl + W
Ctrl + Shift + C
Ctrl + Insert
Shift + Insert
Ctrl + Alt + O
Copy Graph
File New
Window Tile Horizontal
Add New Graph
Open Layout File
Print Page
Save Layout
Window Tile Vertical
Paste Graph
Cut Graph
Waveform Collection (Toggle)
Copy to Clipboard
Copy Graph (same as Ctrl + C)
Paste Graph (same as Ctrl + V)
Options Dialog
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 65 -
4.
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
LOCATION
The purpose of this section is to familiarize you with setting up and using the software location modes. Location is
the process of collecting incoming hits into events & analyzing the arrival times of the hits in an event to produce a
source location. The individual location modes have several key differences which are summarized in the table
below.
Location
Mode
Hits
Used
Zonal
Linear
Tank Bottom
2D Planar
2D Planar (xy)
2D Planar (yz)
2D Planar (xz)
3
3-8
3-8
Cylinder
3-8
Conical
Spherical
3-8
3-8
3D
Location
3D T0
Location
4-8
5-8
Description
Trivial solution to location. Identifies the sensor closest to the
source using the relative arrival times of the hits. Returns the first
hit sensor coordinates as source location.
Designed for 1 dimensional location on a line. Performs linear
interpolation between 2 sensors' coordinates based on differences in
the arrival times of the first 2 hits in the event.
Designed for analyzing 2D circular arrays of sensors.
Designed for an arbitrary array of sensors on a 2D plane.
2D Planar designed to complement 3D Location. Locates using just
2 of the 3D coordinates & ignores the 3rd. Useful for some events
that fail normal 3D Location.
2D Planar analysis wrapped around a 3D cylindrical shell. The
ends of the cylinder may be open or have flat, spherical or elliptical
endcaps. Assumes sound travel through cylinder shell rather than
its interior.
2D Planar wrapped around a 3D conical shell.
2D Planar wrapped around a 3D spherical shell again assuming
sound travel via the shell only.
2D Planar extended to 3D coordinates assuming sound travel
directly through space rather than via an external shell.
3D Location with time zero input. Assumes all events are signaled
via one channel that accurately indicates the absolute start time of
an event.
Analysis
Type
Required
Option
Single
Standard
Single
Standard
Single
Regression
Tank Bottom
Full
Regression
3D
Regression
Full
Regression
Regression
Full
Spherical
Regression
Regression
3D
Location
3D T0
Location
The most important difference in the location modes is the geometry they are designed for. The geometry in turn
affects the number of hits used per event to calculate the location. The type of analysis also affects the number of
hits used in an event. The single analysis modes use just enough hits to create one set of simultaneous equations
which are then solved to extract the source location coordinates. A more complex approach uses more hits &
multiple regression analysis to produce the source location that best fits all the available data. By using data from
extra sensors, the regression modes yield a more accurate source location with improved immunity to errors in the
individual arrival times. For more details, see the section 4.1, Theoretical Background.
Two location modes, zonal & linear, are standard features. Others are location enhancements that require additional
licensing options. If you are not sure what locations options are enabled in your software, look for the Options
dialog available on the Help pulldown menu. It will show a checkmark next to any purchased options. If you wish
to purchase additional license options for other location modes, contact Physical Acoustics Corp. at 1-609-716-4000.
4.1
Theoretical Background
The following section provides a brief overview of the math behind location. It is definitely not required that the
average user to comprehend this material. It's purpose is to educate the inquisitive & allow the user additional
insight into what location is doing behind the scenes.
The fundamental basis for the location calculation is just the simple time-distance relationship implied by the
velocity of the sound wave. The absolute arrival time, t, of a hit in an event can combine with the velocity, v, of the
sound wave to yield the distance, d, from the sensor to the source.
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 66 -
Rev. 1.90
d = v*t
Chapter IV
(1)
The distance between 2 points depends on the geometry of the problem. The majority of the location modes are a
variation of 2 dimensional source location in a plane, although in many cases the 2D plane will wrap around a 3
dimensional object. For 2 points in a flat plane, the distance equation is just the Pythagorean theorem expressed in
Cartesian coordinates:
d = ( x2 x1 ) 2 + ( y2 y1 ) 2
(2)
This calculation is complicated by the lack of knowledge of the exact time the event originated. To get around that
problem, all the times are considered relative to the first hit in the event. Each arrival time difference implies a
difference in distance to the sensor relative to the distance to the first hit sensor. For the second hit sensor relative to
the first hit sensor, a difference equation can be written as:
t2 t1 = ( d 2 d1 ) / v
(3)
The distance equation (2) can be combined with the difference equation (3) to yield:
t 2 t1 = [ ( x2 x S ) 2 + ( y 2 y S ) 2 ( x1 x S ) 2 + ( y1 y S ) 2 ] / v
(4)
where xS & yS are the unknown coordinates of the source. This equation contains 2 unknowns & cannot be solved
by itself. To get a second equation with the same 2 unknowns, a 3rd hit is added to the event producing analogous
equation:
t 3 t1 = [ ( x3 x S ) 2 + ( y3 y S ) 2 ( x1 xS ) 2 + ( y1 y S ) 2 ] / v
(5)
These simultaneous equations can then be solved for xS & yS, although the algebra is fairly comp lex. Tank Bottom
location uses this particular approach to produce a source location from 3 hits as did the original version of 2D
Planar location before it was extended to include multiple regression analysis.
If there are additional hits added to the event, there is a question of how to use the extra information. In the case of
Tank Bottom location, the algorithm simply takes the extra hits & tries them 3 at a time to produce extra source
locations. It iterates through all the 3 hit combinations of the hits in the event until it exhausts them or runs into a
user specified maximum. The problem with this approach is that it produces more than one source location per
event & if there is any error in the timing values, the source location can be wildly incorrect. A better approach
would be to average the data somehow to produce a single location.
Multiple regression analysis does just that, although it does not actually average the results of multiple 3 hit
calculations directly. Rather it searches for the location that best fits all the all the available data. Each additional
hit basically adds an extra equation to the set of simultaneous equations given above as (4) & (5). This can be
generalized as:
t i t1 = [ ( xi x S ) 2 + ( yi y S ) 2 ( x1 x S ) 2 + ( y1 y S ) 2 ] / v
(6)
If one defines
t i = t i t1
(7)
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 67 -
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
t i = [ ( xi x S ) 2 + ( y i y S ) 2 ( x1 x S ) 2 + ( y1 y S ) 2 ] / v
(8)
Equations (7) & (8) give 2 ways of calculating the t of the ith sensor. Using the known arrival times of the hits,
equation (7) calculates the observed time difference, ti,obs,. For a given set of source location coordinates, equation
(8) defines the calculated time difference, ti,calc. Multiple regression analysis is a general purpose algorithm that
minimizes the difference between 2 quantities which in this case are the observed & calculated t values. To do that
2
a quantity called (chi square) is calculated. In our case, it is defined as a sum across all sensors in the event:
2 = ( t i ,obs t i, calc) 2
(9)
This quantity is also called the fit value and is dependent on the x,y coordinates of the source location . The sum is
2
recalculated for each potential source location. Assuming no error in the data, will have a value of 0 at the
2
source location. The location code searches for the values of xS & yS that minimize the value of . The process is
an iterative search, because it is not possible to directly write down simple equations for the values of xS & y S that
2
minimize .
The search is performed using one of 2 algorithms, either a Simplex search (3D or 2D Planar modes) or Powell's
Method (Spherical, Cylinder & Conical Location). Both search methods are based in general on code & algorithms
described in Numerical Recipes in C, 2nd edition (NRC). The code has obviously been heavily adapted for the
problem of acoustic emission source location, so there are significant variations from the NRC originals. The
interested user may, however, find more information about Simplex & Powell fitting & searching in NRC in chapter
10 & more information on regression analysis in chapter 15.
The math gets more complicated when extended to 3 dimensions or involves wrapping around a 3D object, but the
approach is still basically the same. An important point is that the regression approach is no longer over determined
in the case of the event containing the minimum number of hits, i.e. 3 hits for 2D Planar. In that case, however,
regression analysis turns out to be mathematically equivalent to solving the complicated algebra of equations (4) &
(5) & yields the same location coordinates.
4.2
When setting up location groups, you use the Location Setup dialog box (F8 shortcut key). It has 2 tabs labeled
General and Timing. Source locations are produced by analyzing events. Events are just collections of hits & their
associated time of arrival. The settings on the General page control how hits are combined into events & how events
are analyzed by the location modes to produce source locations. The settings on the Timing page control how the
time of arrival of each individual hit is determined and even whether or not a hit is considered significant or
excluded from the location analysis.
You should be aware of the F5 function key. It allows the user to quickly set all rows in a column of the grid to the
value of the current cell. It works on both the General & the Timing tabs. In the example setup shown below,
pressing F5 would set all rows of the Overcal column to the current cell's value of 200.
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 68 -
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
The layout for the General tab is shown above. The grid on the General page of Location Setup contains a list of
location groups & their type. If you click an entry in the Location Type column, an arrow appears allowing you to
change the type. As mentioned above, many location types (3D, Spherical, Cylinder) appear only if you have
purchased the appropriate option.
Group #: This column acts as an On/Off setting. Unchecked groups are ignored when doing a replay.
Show All Points: This column allows the user to show all source results for events that this group can successfully
locate. Independent of which groups have Show All Points checked, the software always allows all enabled groups
to analyze a given event to get the best results for each group and then compares the results from all successful
groups to come up with a best result. For example, linear location is always presumed to give a better result that
zonal location, if there are enough hits(2) to produce a location. If no groups have Show All Points checked, the
software will report one source location per event & it is the best result that is shown on graphs & in the line display.
There are times when a side-by-side comparison of the results of 2 locations groups are useful. In that case you can
mark the groups as Show All Points & then whatever source locations they can calculate will be reported. The
software will appear to sometimes produce more than one source location per event & if you look at the line display,
you will see extra event listings with the same first hit times. The extra location results will also show up as extra
points on your graphs too, but they only count as 1 event in the Statistics bar. In all cases you will see the software's
best result as one of the points. There will be times when an event cannot be located by more than 1 group, so
having Show All Points does not guarantee a result from a given location group. It is only a guarantee that you will
see it, if it can produce a useful result.
Location Type: The Location Type column lets you specify which location mode to use with this particular
location group. If you click on a cell in this column, a down arrow appears on the right hand side of the cell. If you
click the down arrow, a drop down list of the available location choices will appear. The available choices do
depend on the software licensing options as mentioned in the introduction, so you may not see all the location modes
that are discussed in this manual.
Wave Velocity: The Wave Velocity is the expected rate of propagation of the acoustic emission signal you wish to
monitor. It is entered in the users Distance Units per sec. For example, if the Distance Units are in Inches, then the
Wave Velocity takes units of Inches/sec. If the user's Distance Units are time based, this column is ignored by the
location algorithm. The Materials button will allow you to access a database of known velocities for various
materials. See the section on the Material Properties dialog for more information. It is always recommended that
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 69 -
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
you determine the appropriate value by measuring the velocity on your test structure using, for example, pencil lead
breaks.
Event Definition Value: This Event Definition Value is the length of an event in the users Distance units. If the
users Distance Units are time based, then it is directly the maximum time allowed between first & last hits in an
event. If the user units are distance based, the length is later converted to time units using the velocity entered in the
Wave Velocity column. The velocity units are the user's Distance Units per second. For example, if the Distance
Units is set to meters, then the velocity units are meters/sec.
Event Lockout Value: The Event Lockout Value is also a length of time or distance entered in user units, but it
controls the interval between consecutive events. The Event Lockout of the last located event blocks events in all
location groups until it has expired. The Event Definition Value & the Event Lockout Value are both specified
relative to the start of the event (time of test of the first hit). An Event Lockout Value of 0 allows overlapping
events in 2 different location groups. Overlapping events are not permitted in the same location group no matter
what the Event Lockout Value is. An Event Lockout Value larger than the Event Definition Value allows hits to be
ignored after an event, for example, if reflections could generate extraneous acoustic signals.
Overcal Value: The Overcal Value or more fully the over-calibration value is also a length that is specified in the
users Distance Units. Before data acquisition or a replay begins, the software calculates a table of calibrated time
differences between sensors using their known coordinates & the user entered wave velocity. The Overcal Value is
also converted to a time value if needed. After the first hit in an event, these calibrations times are compared to the
time difference of later hits relative to the first hit sensor. In order for a hit to be included in the event, its time
difference must be less than this calibration time, but there is an allowance for a margin of error. The time
difference can be higher than the calibration time by the Overcal Value & still be included in the event.
Timing Strategies: The Timing Strategies column is used to specify which strategies listed on the Timing page will
be applied to a particular location group. You set up the strategy on the Timing page, but you control whether it is
used with a particular location group using the Timing Strategies column. See the section on the Timing page for
information on the settings for strategies & use of the Timing Strategies column.
Hits/Event Min & Max: The Hits/Event (Hits per Event) columns are related to the regression modes. In theory,
the multiple regression can sum across any number of sensors (hits) in a given event when calculating a fit, but there
are limits in the code. First the absolute minimum number is determined by the mathematical requirements specific
to the location mode. For Spherical, Cylinder Location and all 2D Planar regression modes, the event must contain
at least 3 hits to produce a location. For 3D Location a minimum of 4 hits are required to analyze an event &
produce a location. All regression modes can make use of up to 8 hits in an event.
The Hits/Event Min & Max settings allow the user control over the analysis between these limits. For example, in
2D Planar, a minimum of 3 hits are required to produce a location result, but then this is not an over determined
result. If there is an error in the timing data of any one of the 3 hits, the location calculated will be in error. With 4
or more hits, the regression analysis produces a best fit location that averages out errors in the data. Thus, the user
might want to adjust the Hits/Event Min setting to 4 for 2D Planar to eliminate analysis of 3-hit events. This will
reduce the number of events observed & generally reduce scatter in the results. In some cases, the user might want
to only look at events with a specific number of hits. Setting the Hits/Event Min & Max settings to 4 will limit the
analysis to events with 4 or more hits using only the first 4 hits to form the event.
Max Iterations: The Max Iterations column is also related to the regression modes. In this case, the setting
controls the maximum number of locations evaluated in the search for the best fit location. It is not strictly speaking
the same as the number of times through a search loop for 2 reasons. First some searches can test a variable number
of locations during one pass though the loop. Second other searches use loops within loops. Due to the variable
nature of the search algorithms, the actual number of locations tested can be slightly higher (0-3) than the Max
Iterations setting. A lower Max Iterations setting will terminate long location analyses sooner, but the higher speed
results in lower accuracy in the best fit location produced.
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 70 -
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
When the Location Type is not set to an regression mode, the Max Iteration column & the Hits/Event Min & Max
columns will be disabled. In that case the Max Iterations column displays 0 as iterations are not used for the other
modes. The Hits/Event Min & Max settings will be updated with the number of hits required for the location mode.
For example, the Linear location mode requires 2 hits to produce a location and if Location Type is set to Linear,
Hits/Event Min & Max will both display 2 & the user will not be able to adjust the setting.
4.2.2
Timing strategies processes hits and their accompanying waveform to produce a time of arrival. A list of arrival
times a series of hits is grouped together to form an event. The location modes analyze the arrival time differences
(delta t's) in the event to calculate the source location. For an enabled location mode, the software always analyzes
the event at least once. The first analysis is performed using only the arrival times from the Primary Strategy. If
you use additional strategies with one of the regression modes, the software performs a second event analysis to
refine the source location by adding the arrival times produced by the secondary strategies (1-4) to the event.
The settings for the strategy are on the Timing page, but you control which location groups use them with the
Timing Strategies column on the General page. When you click on a cell in the Timing Strategies column, the
Select Strategies dialog appears as shown below.
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 71 -
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 72 -
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
Derive from Waveform: The Derive From Waveform checkbox controls whether the strategy attempts to extract
the arrival time from the waveform. If it is disabled (unchecked), the arrival time can still vary from that produced
by the Primary Strategy if the Timing Feature for the secondary strategy varies from the Primary Timing Feature
setting.
Enable Filter: The Enable Filter checkbox controls whether a digital is applied to the waveform before the arrival
time is determined.
Evaluation Threshold: The Evaluation Threshold is similar to the Hardware Setup Threshold used during data
acquisition. If the Timing Feature is set to FTC (First Threshold Crossing), the Threshold directly impacts the
arrival time or even whether an arrival is detected. The Evaluation Threshold is applied to the waveform after the
optional digital filter is applied. Note that the Hardware Setup Threshold affects what data is recorded during
acquisition. The user can set the Evaluation Threshold to values higher than the Hardware Setup Threshold used
during data acquisition & simulate the results that would have been recorded during acquisition with a higher
Threshold. Beware, though, setting it to lower values cannot reveal data that was not recorded in the first place.
Upper & Lower Frequency: Lower Frequency & Upper Frequency columns control the bandpass cutoff
frequencies. Turning on the digital filter & adjusting the filter cutoff frequencies can help isolate individual acoustic
emission modes with differing wave velocities. Note that you should be aware of the sampling rate used during
acquisition and avoid setting the Lower Frequency cutoff above the lowest sampling rate on any channel. You
should also avoid targeting frequency ranges that your sensors do not respond to or that have been removed by your
hardware's analog filters. Otherwise you could be analyzing meaningless waveforms.
4.2.3
Pressing the Distance Units button opens the Distance Units dialog
box. The user can select his desired units from the dropdown list.
The user is given an option of converting old numerical values to the
new units by simply checking the "Convert all numerical values
based on new units." option. This will cause the event definition
value, event lockout value, the overcal settings, the wave velocities
& sensor positions to be updated as appropriate.
Figure 82. Distance Units
4.2.4
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 73 -
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
4.2.5
Attenuation Dialog
Pressing the Attenuation button opens the Attenuation dialog box shown below. The sole purpose of this dialog is
to allow the software to account for the decay of the acoustic emmission as a function of distance travelled & to
estimate of the initial amplitude at the source. It uses the amplitude observed at the first hit sensor, the distance to
the source for the event and the attenuation table entered by the user in this dialog. The attenuation table documents
amplitude as a function of distance. The units of distance are controlled by the Location Setup Distance Units
setting. The Update button will causes the graph to display the current values in the table. The user may use the
Save & Recall buttons to save or recall an attenuation table to/from the disk
The basic procedure uses the table to calculate the difference
between an amplitude at the source & at the observed distance
from the source. If the source to first hit sensor dis tance falls
within the range of values in the table, an amplitude at that
distance is calculated using linear interpolation between the 2
nearest distances in the table. Using the table above as an
example, if the source was determined to be 2.5 feet from the
first hit sensor, the table has the 2 closest entries as 68 at 2.0
feet & 62 at 3.0. The amplitude predicted at 2.5 feet would be
65 (= 68 (68-62)*0.5).
The correction applied to the
amplitude at the first hit sensor would be 25 dB (= 90 - 65). If
the first hit amplitude was 60, the line display would report a
Source Amplitude of 85 for this example. The amplitudes are
not extrapolated beyond the maximum distance. If the distance
is beyond the maximum distance in the table, only the
maximum correction of 46 (= 90 44) is applied. If the user
never accesses this dialog to fill in the table, no correction is
applied & the source amplitude reported is identical to the
amplitude of the first hit sensor.
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 74 -
4.2.6
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
Pressing this button opens the Guard Sensors dialog box. Guard Sensors can be used to lockout out events on
selected location groups whenever a hit is first detected on a guard channel. It is designed for situations in which
one wishes to ignore events that originate outside of the location group.
In the example setup shown, sensors 1, 3 & 5 are protecting Location Group 1 from outside events. If there is a hit
on sensors 1, 3 or 5, then Location Group 1 will not process any events for the next 1000 us. If the Event Only flag
were checked, only the next event on Location Group 1 would be locked out instead of being locked out for the next
1000us. The Lockout Time field would also be disabled as it's value would no longer be used.
The Guard Data Filter Setup controls what hits get saved into the DTA file during acquisition, if guard sensors are
enabled. The default setting is to just save all hits, but you can restrict the data saved to just those hits that make up
events & the guard sensor hits. This can be useful in situations where external noise creates a large number of hits
that end up being useless for the purpose of location. Not only do the extra hits take up space in the data file, but
they also slow down replays of the data file too.
4.3
Before discussing the Sensor Placement Dialog, there is one important point about the physical placement of your
sensors that you should understand and it applies to all of the regression location modes. You can place sensors
anywhere, but you will get better results with the regression location modes if your sensor layout is made up of an
evenly spaced triangular array of sensors. The optimal arrangement would be a triangular grid made up of
equilateral triangles, but the regression modes do not require exact equality of the triangle legs or even regular
spacing between the sensors. Avoid creating triangles with one very long or very short side, however, as they do
not work well for locating sources.
Pressing the Location View button in the Location Setup
dialog opens the Sensor Placement dialog box. shown here.
The 2 main areas are the actual view of the sensors in the
left-hand side of the dialog & a listing of their coordinates in
the right-hand side. The grid area for the sensor coordinates
also has tabs that will display the coordinates of any welds
and nozzles created. You can change the color of the sensors
using the Graphing menu to access Sensor Color on the
Colors submenu.
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 75 -
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
The Structure list is just below the grid area. Support for welds, nozzles, manual
placement of sensors & autoplacement of sensors varies with the Structure setting.
When creating a sensor layout for a new location group, the first thing you should do in
the Sensor Placement dialog is to set the Structure list. The Group # setting allows you
to quickly switch to editing the sensors for another location group without having to
return to the Location Setup dialog. If you made changes to the current settings, you
are prompted to save them.
Below the Structure setting is the Dimension button. If you click it, one
of the dimensions dialogs will appear. They are also specific to the type
of Structure. The one shown to the right is for the Plate structure. When
working with a new location group, the second thing you should do in
Sensor Placement is to fill in the dimensions for the structure you are
working with. The dimensions affect the scaling of the sensor view
area. If you have incorrect values entered, some sensors may not be
visible in the sensor view.
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 76 -
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
As mentioned in the section describing the Sensor Placement Dialog, there is a point that all users should understand
about the regression location modes & it is important enough to bear repeating. You can place sensors anywhere,
but you will get better results with the regression modes if your sensor layout is made up of an evenly spaced
triangular array of sensors. The optimal arrangement would be a triangular grid made up of equilateral triangles,
but the regression modes do not require exact equality of the triangle legs or even regular spacing between the
sensors. Avoid creating triangles with one very long or very short side, however, as they do not work well for
locating sources.
In general, you can just read the section on the location mode you are interested in using. All the regression location
modes are a variation on 2D Planar, however, so you might also want to read it as well. If you'd like more
information on setting up a Zonal, Linear or Tank Bottom location group, see the Examples section.
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 77 -
4.4.1
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
There is no fundamental difference between 2D Planar & 2D Planar (XY) location except on the menus. Enabling
3D Location also enables 2D Planar (YZ) & 2D Planar (XZ) location. To distinguish the standard 2D Planar from
those 2 modes, it is relabeled 2D Planar (XY) location whenever the 3D Location option is enabled. 2D Planar (YZ)
& 2D Planar (XZ) location are discussed in the section on 3D Location.
For 2D Planar location, a particularly difficult problem is locating the source of an acoustic emission event, if all the
hits are from sensors in a straight line (linear events). For linear events, even if a distance from the line can be
determined, there is no way to distinguish positive & negative directions away from the line. Random error in the
data can also make determining the distance from the line highly suspect. The software filters out linear events and
does not attempt 2D Planar location on them. To avoid lots of linear events that will be ignored, avoid laying out
your sensors like the bad layout shown below.
A better layout would have all distances in between the sensors approximately equal. Triangles with one very long
side or one very short side can also cause problems as they approach becoming a straight line of sensors. The ideal
2D Planar layout would be made up of equilateral triangles, but exact equality of all sides is not required as shown
in the good layout above . As mentioned in the introduction, you should avoid creating triangles with one very long
side or one very short side. Events based on triangles with one very long or very short side become linear events
when one side goes to infinity or to 0. Short of those limits, though, they can still act similar to the linear events,
and won't accurately locate any sources outside of the triangle..
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 78 -
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 79 -
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
After setting up the sensors & a 2D Planar location groups, you will want
to create a location graph. Use the Graphing pulldown menu's New Graph
option & then configure the graph using the Graph Setup dialog box (F3
shortcut key). To the right is a 2D X-Y location graph based on the 2D
Binned Scatter graph type where the location group is using a Plate
structure. If you create a 2D Binned Scatter, 2D Colored Scatter or 2D
Scatter graph that uses X & Y Position, the graph will automatically draw
the sensors on the plot for any location groups selected on the Event
Groups tab. In the Graph Setup dialog, make sure that the Input Data is
set to Events and use the Event Groups tab to select which location
group(s) to use for source information. Below is the corresponding Graph
Setup dialog to illustrate the typical settings.
Figure 95. 2D Planar Graph
4.4.2
Primarily this section focuses on 3D Location, but 2D Planar (YZ) & 2D Planar (XZ) are related. All 3 location
modes are designed to use 3D coordinates. The 2D Planar (YZ) & 2D Planar (XZ) modes are similar to normal 2D
Planar & 2D Planar (XY) location with the exception that you can enter 3D coordinates & have the software locate
the source while ignoring either the X or Y coordinate. The reason these modes are useful relates to a problem with
sensor placement & event handling for 3D Location.
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 80 -
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
The equivalent of the linear event problem for 2D Planar location is a problem with planar events for 3D Location.
A planar event is one in which all the hits are on sensors in the same plane. For planar events, it is hard to determine
distance from the plane not to mention distinguishing sources in the positive direction from those in the negative
direction. The 3D Location algorithm filters out planar events and does not attempt to locate them as the distance
from the plane is often quite simply useless.
Because of the planar problem, you will get better results if you set up your sensors to minimize the number of
sensors that line up across the body of the test structure. Avoid using a rectangular grid layout that lines up sensors
on opposing faces of your structure. Instead try to stagger the sensors, so that no 2 sensors are directly across from
one another. The bad sample layout above uses a rectangular approach with 3 rows of 3 sensors directly opposite
one another. The good layout uses a triangular approach by staggering each row on one side by half the sensorsensor distance and then it inverts the pattern on the opposite wall. The diagram may not show it well, but sensor 4
is below the midpoint of sensors 1&2, above the midpoint of 7&8 and across from the midpoint of 12&13. Both
sides have 3 rows of sensors, but the left-hand side has 3-2-3 pattern of sensors, while the right-hand side has a 2-3-2
pattern of sensors. This staggering minimizes the number of sensor planes through the body of the structure.
One problem with 3D Location filtering out planar events is that pencil lead breaks will not locate with 3D Location
unless the lead break is energetic enough to register with a sensor on one of the other faces. A good alternative in
this case are the 2D Planar (XZ) & (YZ) location modes. The distinction between them is what sensor coordinates
they use when fitting the data. Both allow you to enter 3D coordinates, but ignore one of the values when locating.
2D Planar (XZ) use the X & Z sensor coordinates & ignores the Y values. 2D Planar (YZ) ignores the X coordinate.
They are useful when doing pencil lead breaks by sensors confined to one face of your structure. With the 3D
Location option enabled, 2D Planar (XY) will allow you to enter 3D coordinates & only locate using the x & y
coordinates. Fundamentally that's no different than the standard 2D Planar location. Both are ignoring the z
coordinate , but as a convenience one allows you to enter a non-zero value for Z.
For best performance, any 2D Planar groups using 3D coordinates should be confined to just one face of the test
structure. Parallel sensors on an opposing face could appear as duplicate sensors with identical coordinates when
the 3rd unused coordinate is ignored & that would lead to errors in the event location calculations. You should also
note that during acquisition a result from a 2D location mode does not necessarily imply that the source was
confined to the 2D location plane. Just as for planar events in 3D Location, distance from the plane is indeterminate.
You can draw a perpendicular to the 2D plane at the best fit location and the source event could be anywhere on the
line. Of course for pencil lead breaks, you will know in advance that the source is confined to a given face and be
able to check your sensors before starting acquisition.
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 81 -
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
For 3D Location, the Sensor Placement dialog shown here allows you to directly enter X, Y, Z coordinates for any
groups that are considered a 3D Location group with the right structure type. 3D Location is designed to use either
the Free or the Box structure types.
The Dimensions dialog for the Box & Free structures is similar to the
one for the 2D Free or Plate structures with the addition of max/min
settings for the Z axis. Similar to the way the Plate structure limits 2D
Planar results, the Box structure acts as search limits for 3D Location. If
any location results are more than 2% above or below the limits, the
result will be considered bad & is thrown out. For example, if Z Min is
50 & Z Max is 150, then any location results where z is above 152 or
below 48 will be filtered out. As with 2D Planar, using the Free
structure avoid imposing any limits on the results.
Figure 100. Box
You cannot graphically enter 3D sensor locations in Sensor Placement, but you can graphically see the sensors in the
3D view. If you do not see a grid column for Z or a 3D view of your sensors, go back to the Location Setup dialog
& make sure the group type is set to 3D Location, 2D Planar (YZ) or (XZ). Also make sure you have the structure
type set to Free or Box.
Use the INS key & F2 to insert a new sensor & edit its coordinates in the grid. As an alternative to creating all the
sensors manually, you can also use the AutoPlace Sensors option to create a grid of sensors with varying x,y
coordinates & a fixed z coordinate of 0. You would then manually edit the z coordinates of each sensor. Note that
you can use AutoPlace Sensors multiple times without erasing the old sensors. That allows you to build up a 3D
grid one layer at a time. Right click the graph in Sensor Placement to find AutoPlace Sensors.
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 82 -
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
You can also create 2D location plots using X, Y & Z Position settings on a 2D Binned Scatter graph as done in the
section on 2D Planar. If you do, the sensors will also draw on the 2D plots using 2 of the 3 sensor coordinates
ignoring the unused dimension. For example, an X & Z Position graph would show the sensors at their x & z
coordinates & ignore their y coordinate. This allows you to create front, top and side views of your structure as
shown below. These graphs also illustrate another benefit to staggering your sensor locations legible sensor
markers. If your sensors line up on opposing faces, you will end up with overlaid sensor markers on the 2D graphs.
That can make them hard to read.
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 83 -
4.4.3
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
Spherical Location
Using Spherical location is similar to using the 2D Planar location mode, although there are differences in the
coordinate system used & & how a typical location plot is set up. Mathematically, Spherical location behaves like
2D Planar where both axes wrap back around on themselves. There aren't any new pitfalls in sensor placement, but
the linear event problem that affects 2D Planar also affects Spherical. If you attempt location using just 4 sensors on
the equator of a sphere, Spherical location would always fail as all events would be due to sensors in a straight line.
For better results, use at least 6 sensors (north & south poles & 4 evenly spaced on the equator). The maximum
number of sensors is limited only by the number of available hardware channels. When using more than 6 sensors,
it is recommended that you stagger alternate rows of the sensors to yield a triangular grid and produce more
locatable events.
The Sensor Placement dialog has been
enhanced to allow you to directly enter
theta & phi coordinates anytime the
structure type is set to Sphere as
shown here. Sensor coordinates are
entered in degrees. Theta is defined as
the north/south angle (latitude) and
should be between +90 and 90. +90
is 90 degrees north (top of the sphere),
while 90 is 90 degrees south (bottom
of the sphere). Phi is the east/west
angle (longitude) and ranges between
+180 & 180. A phi of +90 is 90 east
(right), while 90 is 90 west (left)
relative to the origin. +180 (east) and
180 (west) are actually the same
location due to the wrapping of the
sphere. A white + symbol marks the
theta, phi origin of 0,0. You can
quickly generate sensor layouts with
the AutoPlace Sensors dialog. Just
right click the graph in the Sensor
Placement dialog. Alternatively you
can use the INS key to manually insert
a new sensor & then edit the sensor
coordinates on the sensor grid.
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 84 -
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
After setting up the sensors & each of the location groups, you
will want to create location graphs to display the results. It is
possible to use any of the standard 2D graph types and display
theta or phi on one of the axes. Just pick Theta Position or Phi
Position from the list of available features. The easiest way,
however, is to use a Spherical Location graph like the one
shown at the right.
In use, a Spherical Location graph can contain a maximum of
4095 data points. During acquisition or replay, the newest data
points replace the oldest ones on the graph once the 4095 point
limit is reached.
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 85 -
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
the plot for any spherical location groups selected on the Event Groups tab. If you do not see a sphere on the graph
after you exit Graph Setup, go back into Graph Setup & make sure at least one spherical location group is selected in
Event Groups.
There is an Options section specific to the Spherical Location plot. It contains Transparency Level, Point Size,
View Direction, Spherical Grid Spacing & Cartesian Grid Planes. Here is brief description of what they do.
Transparency Level: The Transparency Level can vary between 0 and 100%. When set to 0%, the sphere becomes
opaque & points that plot on the back side of the sphere are not visible. If you use 25 or 50%, the points on the back
side become visible, but are a darker shade than those on the front side.
Point Size: Point Size directly affects the size of the data points & the sensor markers. The Spherical Location plot
draws both the sensors & the data points as small diamonds. A bigger Point Size yields bigger data points & bigger
sensor markers. The sensor markers are always slightly larger than the data points. You may also use the Graphing
Colors menu to change the colors of the sensors, data points and the sphere (structure color). The data points use the
Plot 1 color in Plot Colors.
View Direction: The View Direction setting in Graph Setup controls what angle the sphere is viewed from using the
same conventions as the sensor coordinates. This allows you to create top, bottom and side views of your sphere.
For example, if you enter Theta = -90 and Phi = 0, the sphere will draw as if you are looking directly at the south
pole. Below is a page of sample graphs from the SphereDemo.lay example file.
- 86 -
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
Legs Grid: This option turns on an additional grid for the legs.
4.4.4
Cylinder Location
Cylinder Location is designed for locating source emissions on a cylinder with either flat, elliptical, or hemispherical
endcaps or no endcaps at all. It is similar to 2D Planar Location with the x, y coordinates being the unwrapped
cylinder distances, but one or both of the axes wraps around the body of the cylinder.
When setting up your sensors on your cylinder, there are several guidelines to keep in mind. As with 2D Planar, the
software cannot successfully locate any source when all the hits are from sensors in a single straight line. The
advice on good vs. bad sensor layouts for 2D Planar applies here too. Avoid rectangular sensor layouts where the
distance between rows differs greatly from the distance between columns as shown in the Bad 2D Planar Layout
diagram. As stated before, the optimal arrangement would be a triangular grid made up of equilateral triangles. For
Cylinder location, also be sure your sensor triangles on the heads are not significantly different in size than the
triangles on the body especially if your cylinder has flat heads. If you do so, you may get spurious event locations
clustering along the head-body border.
Sensors that are 180 degrees apart can also cause mathematically invalid events too. Geometrically, it is similar to
problem with a straight line of sensors. If an event consists of a sensor on one side of the cylinder & 2 others
exactly 180 degrees around the body, there is no way to distinguish source locations in the positive direction from
the negative . Generally it is recommended that you use 3 sensors around the circumference of the cylinder in a
given row. If you must use 2 sensors per ring around the cylinder, definitely stagger the alternate rows or else you
will not see any locatable events.
Use the Sensor Placement dialog shown below to set up the cylinder as well as place your sensors. Cylinder
location is only designed to be used with the Horizontal or Vertical Vessel structure types. For Cylinder location,
the Structure list in Sensor Placement must be set to either Horizontal or Vertical Vessel (cylinder) as shown above.
You will receive a warning if you attempt acquisition or replay with a Cylinder location group that attempts to use
any other kind of structure.
- 87 -
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
By default, Sensor Placement shows a 3D cylinder view. If you prefer a 2D view, simply uncheck the 3D View
option at the bottom of the dialog & you will be presented with an unwrapped 2D view of the cylinder shown below.
There is also a dropdown list to select the type of Head on the cylinder. Available choices are Spherical, Flat,
Elliptical & None. If a head type other than None is selected, the body rectangle drawn in Sensor Placement will
have 2 additional rectangles on the top & bottom (Vertical Vessel) or left & right ends (Horizontal Vessel). The
head rectangles extended the body rectangle by a distance determined by the head type. For Spherical or Flat, it is
the length of the cap radius which is also the body radius and half the user entered diameter. In the horizontal case,
the rectangle will extend along the x axis from radius to Length+radius, while in the vertical case the y axis will
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 88 -
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
run from radius to Height+radius. For Elliptical heads, a 2:1 ratio is assumed between the body radius & the
perpendicular head radius, so the distance is the body radius or the user entered diameter.
You can quickly generate rectangular & triangular sensor layouts with the AutoPlace Sensors dialog available by
right clicking on the sensor view. If you are using the 2D view of the cylinder, you can also manually place sensors
on the cylinder by right clicking. After using either option, you can edit the coordinates of the sensors if structural
features (valves, nozzles, welds) require shifting sensors around. Just enter the x,y coordinates in the users
preferred distance units.
When you enter sensor coordinates & you are not including the caps, express your x, y coordinates with a lower
limit of 0 and an upper limit of the circumference or the length/height. For example, when working with a vertical
cylinder of height 150 and diameter 63.66 (circumference = 200), express x as a value from 0 to +200 and y as value
from 0 to +150. Basically, just make sure your sensor is visible in the body rectangle drawn in the Sensor
Placement dialog.
If you are using Spherical or Flat heads, these limits are widened for the y axis by the radius to 31.83 to +181.83.
These extensions allow for the entry of sensors on the heads. For this vertical cylinder, a pole sensor on the bottom
cap would have a y coordinate of -31.83. The x coordinate for a cap on a vertical cylinder corresponds to a rotation
angle, but is entered as a fraction of the body circumference. In this case the limits are 0 to +200 and sensors placed
120 (=360/3) degrees apart are separated by 66.67 (=200/3). For a cap sensor placed directly at the pole of the
hemisphere, the rotation angle is unimportant in the source location calculations, but a value of half the
circumference will place the sensor halfway up the cap rectangle border. In the case of the vertical cylinder shown
above, the pole sensor on the bottom cap is at -31.83, +100 (any x really) and +181.83, +100 for the top cap.
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 89 -
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
The Spherical Grid Spacing option is replaced by the Cylinder Grid Spacing option, although it behaves in a similar
fashion. You may set the Cylinder Grid Spacing to None, 10%, 20%, 25%, 50% or 100% to control the appearance
of a grid overlaid onto the surface of the cylinder. The percentages are applied to the heads & the body separately as
the dimensions for the 2 regions can vary greatly. If the user selects a grid spacing of 25%, the body will be divided
up into 4 equal regions and the head will also be divided up into 4 regions. If the user selects 100%, only the
boundary between the heads & the body will be marked. Cylinder Location graphs always use Events as the Input
Data, but as for the 2D graphs, make sure you set the Events Groups to the appropriate location group or your graph
will not show any data & will not draw the cylinder associated with the group.
4.4.5
Conical Location
Conical location is set up almost identically to Cylinder location mode. In Location Setup, the user selects Conical
for the Location Type on the General tab. The other settings in the table are described in the section on the Location
Setup dialog. In Sensor Placement, set the Structure list to Vert. Cone or Horiz. Cone as shown on the next page.
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 90 -
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
The Dimensions button calls up the Cone dimensions dialog allowing the
user to enter the upper & lower diameters as well as the height (or the left
& right diameters & length, if horizontal). The height or length has added
significance when conical location is analyzing data. Conical results are
limited to source locations to within +/- 2% of the height. In other words,
points located wildly off the cone body are thrown out as bad results.
Sensor coordinates are entered as Z & Phi. The Z axis is the cone axis independent of horizontal vs. vertical
configuration. Z starts at 0 at the bottom of the cone & goes up to the height of the cone (or 0 at the left & up to the
length). Phi should be entered between -180 to +180 degrees to keep the sensors within the 2D drawing of the
unrolled cone, although location will work with values from 0-360 as well.
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 91 -
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
You can toggle between 2D & 3D graphs in Sensor placement with the 3D View checkbox. The 2D view translates
the phi value into a fraction of the circumference. The trapezoid is drawn from +circumference/2 to
-circumference/2 where the diameter depends upon the z value in the cone.
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 92 -
4.5
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
Location Examples
It is not feasible to provide detailed examples of all location modes in this manual. There are, however, example
layout files & sample data files for each location mode. When you are starting out with a new location mode, you
can simple recall the sample layout & inspect the location related menus (Location Setup, Sensor Placement &
Graph Setup dialogs). After you learn how the example is set up, you can make changes to better reflect your test
setup & save the modified layout under a new name. Below is a table summarizing the example layouts & data files
for the various location mo des.
Location Mode
Zonal
Linear
Tank Bottom
2D Planar
Cylinder
Conical
Spherical
3D Location
Layout File
Zonal_Linear.lay
Zonal_Linear.lay
TankBot.lay
2D-Planar.lay
OpenCylinderDemo.lay
ConicalDemo.lay
SphereDemo.lay
3dLocDemo.lay
Data File
Zonal_Linear.dta
Zonal_Linear.dta
TankBot.dta
HE-Link.dta
LongVessel.dta
ConicalDemo.dta
SphereDemo.dta
3dLocDemo.dta
In addition to the example files, there are detailed examples given here to illustrate how to use Zonal, Linear, 2D
Planar & Tank Bottom location. The steps in setting up and running a location test are pretty similar no matter what
location mode you are using. Here is an overview of those steps:
1.
Create a layout file with the hardware set up appropriately (e.g. the correct number of sensors turned on,
detection threshold set properly).
2. Bring up the Location Setup dialog (=F8 key) and start by setting the distance units.
3. Next fill in the location group information. Enable the group & select the Location Type. Enter the Wave
Velocity, Event Definition Value & Overcal Value. If this is your first time working with location, leave the
Event Lockout Value, Timing Strategies, Max Iterations, Min & Max Hits/Event at the default values. That
applies to all the settings on the Timing page as well. These parameters are more fully described in section on
the Location Setup dialog under the headings of General Tab Settings & Timing Tab Settings.
4. Next define the sensor locations on the structure using the Sensor Placement dialog. Use the Location View
button in Location Setup to display it.
5. In Sensor Placement, start by selecting the Structure type and then click on Dimensions to enter the appropriate
structure information.
6. Now create your sensors by right clicking the sensor view area & or using INS & F2 in the sensor grid.
7. When finished, click OK in both the Sensor Placement dialog & in the Location Setup dialog.
8. Next create a suitable location graph using the Graphing menu (New Graph) & configure it using the Graph
Setup dialog (=F3 key). See the notes on individual location modes for information on the appropriate location
graphs.
9. Now we are ready to run a trial AE test using pencil lead breaks to verify that everything is set up properly. If
everything works, you're ready for acquisition.
10. If you end up staring at an empty graph, here is a list of things to double-check. Some are obvious, but personal
experience shows them to be easy mistakes.
a. Is the Input Data set to Events in Graph Setup?
b. Is this location group checked on in the Event Groups tab of Graph Setup?
c. Is this location group checked on in the Group # column of Location Setup?
d. Are there any events from the group in the Line Display?
e. If there are events, are the axis limits in Graph Setup wide enough to see the positions?
f. If no events, are the Location Setup settings reasonable? Did you look up a velocity like 10,000 ft/sec &
enter 10,000 when it should be 120,000 because the Distance Units are Inches? Verify the Event Definition
& Lockout Value are reasonable given your sensor spacing & structure type. They all use the same units,
so the values should be related to sensor-sensor spacing.
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 93 -
4.5.1
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
As an easy to set up layout, we will be using two sensors located 30 inches apart. This sensor layout will be used to
illustrate Zonal location in this section & Linear location in the next section. We will be using example layout and
data files called Zonal_Linear.lay and Zonal_Linear.dta which are installed in the AEData directory under your
software program directory, for example "C:\Program Files\Physical Acoustics\AEwin for DiSP\AEData". If you
do not have these sample files, we will be showing the setup screens so that you can duplicate the setup and conduct
your own acquisition test.
In this section we will be setting up a Zonal Location Test following the steps identified above. For the example, we
are assuming that we have two sensors in Channels 1 & 2 of the AE system.
Step 1. Start by using the File pulldown menu to access the Open Layout menu option or press Ctrl-O. Select the
layout file named, Zonal_Linear.lay & recall it.
Step 2. Enter the location setup menu by either pressing the F8 keyboard function key, clicking on the Toolbar icon
that looks like a bullseye target called "Location Setup or select Location on the Acquisition Setup pulldown
menu.
The Location Setup dialog will be displayed as shown below. This is the first menu that needs to be set up in
accordance with our step by step procedure. By default, the General page displays. Notice the General tab near the
top left of the dialog box. The General page of Location Setup allows you to control the setting of the individual
location groups. Up to 8 location groups can be set up, although an additional licensing option provides for up to 32
groups.
In addition, near the bottom center of the dialog, the user can set up the location distance units. Various selections
including Metric, English and time units can be selected for distance units. Selecting a real distance value is most
appropriate since the values read out can be directly measured when trying to locate a source on a structure. Use the
Distance Units button to select inches as in this example.
Step 3. In this example, we will select a Zonal location group as group #1. Follow the Group #1 line and enter the
information as shown. First select the zonal group. This is done by left-clicking the mouse on the right side of the
Group #1, Type box. A dropdown list will appear to allow the user to select from the various alternatives (Zonal,
Linear, etc.). Select Zonal.
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 94 -
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
For the Wave Velocity, the velocity entered will be related to your Distance Units setting. In this case, we've
selected inches as our units, so the velocity is in inches/second. You can look up a velocity using the Material
Properties dialog by clicking on the Material button. The database contains values for Longitudinal, Shear &
Surface velocities. It is often better to directly measure the velocity using the AE system. Simply use the Line
Display mode to determine the actual transit time (t) to traverse between two sensors. You can then divide the
distance between the two sensors by the t to arrive at the estimated velocity. In order to determine this correctly
you really need to simulate the type of defect you are trying to detect. Enter the desired velocity in the edit box. In
our example, we used an aluminum bar and a pencil lead break as a source. Although the Longitudinal velocity is
249,000 inches/second and the Shear velocity is 123,000 inches/second, we experimentally determined a test
velocity of 176,000 inches/second.
For the Event Definition Value, we want to select a generous Event Definition using the same units as the Distance
Units selected. This should be set to make sure that from any point in the location array, a minimum desired number
of sensors will be hit, forming an event. In our example, two sensors 30 inches apart, the Event definition should be
at least 30 inches to make sure that the two sensors get hit within a single event. We have entered 60 in the
example above.
For Event lockout Value, we enter a value (in the selected distance units) to assure that the there is enough time (or
distance) for all additional hits and reflections related to the event have had a chance to die down. The amount of
time or distance selected will be the dead time as we wait for the event to die down. In this example, we will
leave it at the default of 0 as reflections are not expected to be a problem for this setup.
The Overcal value is also set in the selected distance units and is usually set at an amount of approximately 10% to
assure that minor variations in wavepath velocity are not ignored by the location algorithm. When you are just
learning to use location, it is best to leave the settings on the Timing page & the Timing Strategies column at the
defaults. The Max Iterations, Min & Max Hits/Event cannot be changed for Zonal as they are not used by it. They
only apply to the regression location modes. All of these parameters are more fully described in section on the
Location Setup dialog under the headings of General Tab Settings & Timing Tab Settings.
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 95 -
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
Step 4. Once the location group settings have been entered, we can move on and define the sensor placements. This
is done with the Sensor Placement dialog. Click on the Location View button on the bottom right side of Location
Setup to display it. The figure above shows the Sensor Placement dialog box. There are 2 main area to the dialog
box. The sensor layout view on the left-hand side and the sensor grid with the coordinates of individual sensors on
the right hand side.
When we click Location View, the sensor layout for that particular location group is displayed. If we had group 1
highlighted, but wanted to display the sensors for group 5, we could change the group displayed with the Group
dropdown listbox just below the sensor grid. Select Group 1, if it is not already selected.
Step 5. Next, we need to select the Structure. The Structure setting is also just
below the sensor grid & just to the right of the Group setting. This is currently set
to Free. Free allows sensors to be placed anywhere without worrying about the
specific structure geometry such as a plate, box or sphere.
Next, we set the Structure dimensions. For the Free structure, this isn't required for
location, but the dimensions control the axis limits of the graph in the sensor view
area. To change them we click the Dimensions button and the Free dimensions
dialog shown at the right appears. Here we've set the X and Y minimum and
maximum values to 0 & 30.
Step 6. We are now ready to create our sensor layout. In Sensor Placement example above, you can see that the
sensors have already been placed at the bottom of the graph area, at locations of (0, 0) and (30, 0) using an (X, Y)
arrangement. The software makes it very easy to place and move sensors on the screen and to get them in an exact
position.
To place a new sensor, we right click inside the graph
region. The context menu to the right appears. The menu
options we want to concentrate on are on the Sensors
submenu allowing you to perform various functions related
to sensor placement.
Since we want to place a sensor, simply select and click on
the Place Sensor selection. Upon doing so a small menu
box comes up asking you to verify the number of the sensor
Figure 123. Place Sensor
to be placed or to change it. When you're done, click OK
and the mouse cursor will change to a red sensor icon with a
crosshair cursor. Each time you click you will generate another sensor in your layout. Notice the x,y coordinates of the
mouse cursor are shown above the sensor view area. When you are finished placing sensors, right clicking will return
the mouse to its normal arrow shape. Simply follow the right click with a left click off the menu, if you don't need any
of the context menu options. Whatever you do, don't press the ESC key. That is equivalent to pressing the Cancel
button for the dialog & you'll lose all your changes to the sensor layout.
There are 2 ways to move sensors around to correct bad placement. First, the right click Sensors menu has a Move
Sensor option. When you select it, the mouse cursor changes to a red sensor icon with a 4-headed crosshair cursor. To
use it, click on the sensor you want to move. The sensor will turn red. Now click a second time at the spot where you
want to move the sensor & it will shift to the new location. Right clicking ends the Move Sensor mode.
If after graphically placing or moving a sensor, its placement is still not accurate enough, you can alter the position to
an exact value by modifying the X or Y value in the sensor grid. Simply left-click the mouse to highlight the desired
box to be changed and enter the exact value, followed by the Enter key. Alternatively, press the F2 key to edit the
current value.
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 96 -
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
Note the other sensor placement and edit capabilities provided by the submenu. You can automatically place the
Next sensor by number by pressing the Next Sensor button. In this case the sensor channel number selection box
does not come up. It simply enters the Place Sensor mode using the next highest number sensor. Please note and
experiment with these sensor placement management selections.
By now you may have added several sensors to your setup that you want to delete. Do this by right clicking over the
sensor you want to delete and then select Delete Sensor. The mouse cursor with change to a red sensor with a
crosshair labeled "del". When you click on a sensor, a "Delete this sensor?" message box asks for confirmation. Click
Yes, to delete the sensor from the graph and from the table. Again right clicking puts the cursor back to normal.
Return to the original sensor layout as shown above when you are finished exploring the Sensors menu options.
Step 7. In the previous steps we have fully defined the location setup. The next step in the process is to set up graphs
to see our location in acquisition or replay. We do this by first saving our sensor placement & location setup. Click the
OK button in Sensor Placement & then in Location Setup. DO NOT CLICK Cancel in either one as you will lose any
changes you made while in these dialog boxes. This is a very good time to save your layout on disk as well using the
File pulldown Save Layout As menu options. If you don't need to rename the layout, you can just use Ctrl-S to update
the current layout on disk.
Step 8. Next we need to create a suitable location graph. If you have been following along with our example layout
file called Zonal_Linear.lay, you will be seeing a screen like that shown below. In this screen you can see two graphs.
The first or top graph is set up already as a location graph. Since this is being set up for zonal location, we will only see
the activity in a histogram or bar chart type of arrangement.
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 97 -
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
Assuming that this graph was not already set up in the desired location mode, lets go through the steps of setting up the
graph for a Linear or Zonal location. First, we select the graph that we want to change to the location graph. We do
this by right clicking the mouse when it is inside the graph region of the graph that we want to work on. Once we do
that a menu appears. This menu gives us many choices but we will select the top one called Graph Setup. Upon
selecting this a graph setup menu appears like that shown below.
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 98 -
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
The next two edit boxes allow us to set the starting Y-axis Minimum and Maximum settings.
The next checkbox Log Scale allows us to set a log or linear graph scale. Beside it is an Invert checkbox which allows
the user to reverse the positive to negative direction on the axis.
The next 3 radio buttons are related, allowing you to select one type of graph scaling. Manual(Fixed) will force the
graph limits as set above to remain fixed. Compress will compress the graph so that the minimum graph value remains
but the maximum keeps changing as the graph limit is exceeded. And the Slide selection will allow both the minimum
and maximum limits to change or slide as data is received that is beyond the current limits.
The next box allows us to select what type of Input Data we are plotting. In our case since we are plotting a location
graph, we want to choose the Event data for plotting.
Below this is a Show Grid checkbox for displaying a grid on the graph background.
The next column to the right, shows the X (Horizontal) Axis settings. The X-axis settings have similar setup boxes as
were described for the Y-Axis and will not be described here. Just note how they have been set up to display the XPosition for location and that we have set up the minimum and maximum graph values to include the sensor positions
of 0 and 30 inches. Also note that we have selected fixed scaling on the X-axis because we do not expect the X axis
position to change. If this were a time axis we would be using a compression, or sliding graph scaling.
The last column on the right changes according to the graph type being set up. If a 3-D graph were being set up, this
would be the column for the Z-axis setting. However, since we have selected a graph type of 2-D Histogram, settings
for the Value Axis and the Bin Axis appears. Again, for now just note the settings and you can get familiar with what
they do by making a change and seeing how it affects the graph later.
At the bottom of the third column is a checkbox that allows you to decided whether the histogram shows unfilled,
outlined bars or filled solid bars.
Please note and try to make sense of all the selected menu settings. Although it might look complex at the start, if you
have gone through these settings, one at a time you will see that all is quite simple. Exit the graph menu by selecting
the OK button at the top right of the Graph setup menu.
By looking at the top of the graph we see its graph title of Events vs. X Position <1,2> Loc(1). This summarizes
what is being displayed. First is the graph type Events vs. X-Position. Next we are displaying data from channels 1
and 2. Finally, we are displaying results from location group #1.
Now that we are finished, we see that we have set up a Linear location graph and are ready to test it. However, before
we do, we have a second graph located below the first one. Lets take a look at it. By the title, we see that it is an
Events vs. Channel graph, plotting channel 1 and 2 data and also working with data from location group #1. We can
look further to see how this graph is set up by entering the graph set up menu (right clicking within the graph area and
selecting the graph menu selection at the top of the submenu).
Take a look to see how this has been set up. The main difference is in the X-Axis graph parameter and the Bin Axis
setting # of bins. This should help give a little insight into how you can set up different graphs.
Now we are ready to proceed with a test or a replay. As a reminder, as a precaution always save your Layout file
before trying it out. It is not fun to have all your work disappear because power went down or something happened to
lose the layout.
Step 9. The next step after setting up the graphs is to test the layout & verify that it functions properly during
acquisition. We can do this by carrying out a trial acquisition and location test if we have setup our sensors or we can
do this by replaying our test file called Zonal_Linear.DTA . To do this, refer to the sections on going into acquisition
or replay (section 3.4 and 3.5). In our example we will replay the DTA file by going to the Replay function, selecting
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 99 -
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
the file Zonal_Linear.DTA and starting. Upon selecting, our data file is replayed and should look like the graphs
shown below.
The top Events versus position graph shows that all the locations occurred at each of the sensor positions, even though
in reality the events were distributed along the length between the two sensors. You can also see that there are fewer
events on the right side, or from sensor #2. This is confirmed in the Events versus channel graph below the location
graph. The reason for the events showing up at the channel of a Zonal location group is that again the zonal group
provides information on which sensor was hit first.
From the above display it seems that our setup is good and we could proceed on to test with a setup like this. However,
you can modify some of the settings in the graph setup menu & repeat the replay of the data to see how the graphs are
affected by changes and to get familiar with the graphing capabilities.
To illustrate the ease with which changes can be made, we'll now modify the location setup & transform the Zonal
location group into a Linear location group. Simple use F8 to bring up the Location Setup dialog & change the
Location Type of group #1 from Zonal to Linear, Next use F10 to replay Zonal_Linear.DTA again. Note how the
results on the location graph below compare with the results for the zonal location shown above using the same
Zonal_Linear.dta data file. There are now locations along the length of the top graph indicating that some events
have located in between the 2 sensors..
This example shows one of the very nice capabilities built into the software, the ability of changing a setup and
visualizing a different result upon replay. Remember that simply by changing the Zonal setup to a Linear location
setup we got two different graphical results. This is very useful when analyzing data.
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 100 -
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
4.5.2
As a detailed example, we will be setting up a 2D Planar location group with 4 sensors. We will be using the 2DPlanar.lay and chan24.dta example layout and data file and which are in the AEData directory by default. If you do
not have these examples, we will be showing the setup screens so that you can duplicate the setup and conduct your
own acquisition test.
As explained at the beginning of this chapter, 2D Planar location is part of the full location option. You can check
for the full location option using the Options dialog available on the Help pulldown menu. Look for a checkmark
next to Full Location. Alternatively you can just look for 2D Planar in the list of available location modes under the
Location Type column in Location Setup.
2D Planar location lets you place multiple sensors anywhere on your test structure without restricting you to a fixed
grid arrangement. This is convenient as many structures have pipes or valves that may make a fixed triangular or
rectangular arrays of sensors impossible to set up. The position of the source event is calculated from the differences in
arrival times between the first 3 (up to 8) valid hits (2 t values). The positions of the sensors for first 3 hits always
determines a triangle. The ideal arrangement for 2D Planar would be a layout made up of equilateral triangles, but
exact equality of the triangles & sides of the triangles is not an absolute requirement. You will get better results if you
avoid creating sensor triangles where one side of the triangle is much larger or smaller than the other 2.
Setting up for 2D Planar location is very easy in the software and is similar to setting up zonal or linear location.
The steps are identical to those outlined above, only some of the menu selections are changed for the 2D Planar
location. Let's provide a quick run-through of setting up 2D Planar location using the same steps outlined above for
the other location setups. We will be using the example layout file, 2D-Planar.lay.
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 101 -
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
Step 1. Use the File pulldown menu's Open Layout option (Ctrl-O) to recall 2D-Planar.lay.
Step 2. Enter the Location Setup dialog (F8 key) & use the Distance Units button to select Inches.
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 102 -
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
Steps 4-5. Click on Location View to bring up the Sensor Placement dialog. Make sure the Structure type is set to
Free with the Dimensions set to 0 & 30 for Min & Max values.
Steps 6-7. Set up the sensor locations on the screen using the same procedure described in the previous section for
zonal location. The only difference now is that you will set up 4 sensors in a 2 dimensional layout. An example is
shown above along with the coordinates of the 4 sensors. Even though we are showing a triangular arrangement, 2D
Planar is not restricted to a specific sensor pattern. When you are done placing sensors, click OK in Sensor
Placement & Location Setup to return to the main menu.
Step 8. Next, define a 2D X-Y location plot using the graphing menu following the procedure described in the
section for zonal location . The screen capture above shows the graph setup menu for the location plot in 2DPlanar.lay while the one below shows the graph (top graph) for that layout. You can compare the differences
between the setup above and the graph setup for the zonal and linear location graph shown earlier. First, you can
see that we have enabled all 4 sensors for display that have been setup in the location view menu. Next, you can see
that we have selected a 2D Binned Scatter (point plot) for the graph type. Next, you can see that we have changed
the Y-Axis to plot Y-Position instead of Events. You can also see that we have changed the axis coordinates in
both the X and Y axes. Finally, you can see that there is no bin or value axis settings to the right of the X axis
setup as there was for the 2D Histogram graph setup. 2D Binned Scatter graphs don't require any user choices about
the binning strategy. All 2D Binned Scatter graphs use a fixed 200x200 binned grid when plotting the data. The
point of using a 2D Binned Scatter graph rather than a 2D Scatter graph is speed. It's binning strategy decreases the
number of data points actually plotted, so that multiple point at one location graph as just one point. The 2D
Colored Scatter graph is similar to the 2D Binned Scatter, but it will allow you to plot the points in different colors
that reflect how many original data points are superimposed at any particular location.
The result of the graph setup is shown in top graph of the screen below. In this graph you can see the sensor
locations, although your graph will be empty at this point.
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 103 -
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
Tank Bottom location is a specialized AE source location mode, developed specifically for monitoring the floors of
large cylindrical vessels. The software assumes a tank with a circular bottom with sensors equally spaced around
the circumference of the tank. Tank Bottom location should not be confused with TANKPAC. The difference
between them is that Tank Bottom software performs a location calculation and projects the result of that location
determination onto the tank floor graphic. In contrast, TANKPAC is a knowledge & experienced based procedure
for assessing and grading the integrity of tank floors.
If you have purchased the Tank Bottom location software option, this section will help you to setup for your first
Tank Bottom test. Please first verify that you have the Tank Bottom software option by selecting the Options dialog
from the Help pulldown menu. If you have this option, it will be checked. If the option is not present and you
desire it, please contact the Customer Service Department at customerservice@pacndt.com.
Tank Bottom location follows along the same location setup, menus and setup procedure as do the other location
modes. Setting up Tank-Bottom location is a simple 3 step process including;
1.
2.
Accessing the Location Setup menu (F8), from the Acquisition Setup main toolbar menu, and setting up
a Tank Bottom location group.
Accessing the Location View menu to setup the Tank bottom structure, dimensions and sensor placement.
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 104 -
3.
4.
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
Assuming one is familiar with the software, the following is a step by step procedure for setting up and running the
Tank Bottom Location software.
4.5.3.1
It is important to setup your distance units as early as possible into the location setup since all the location setup
entries including Wave Velocity, Event Definition Value, Event Lockout value, and Overcal value all use
the units selected (of course in the case of velocity it will be units/second). By dealing in direct units, the user can
think in terms of distance values when setting up these entries.
Returning to setting up the Group #1 (as shown by the first row of the Location setup menu), we will address each
column entry below.
Group#: The first column shows that we have checkmarked the Group #1 Location group to be an active location
group. Putting a check in this box activates that location group and tells the software to perform a location
calculation on based on the setup data in this menu, the Location setup Timingmenu (see the upper tabs) and the
Location View and Tank Bottom Options.
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 105 -
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
Show All Points: This allows the user to show all source results for events that this group can successfully locate.
Independent of which groups have Show All Points checked, the software always allows all enabled groups to
analyze a given event to get the best results for each group and then compares the results from all successful groups
to come up with a best result. For example, linear location is always presumed to give a better result that zonal
location, if there are enough hits(2) to produce a location. If no groups have Show All Points checked, the software
will report one source location per event & it is the best result that is shown on graphs & in the line display. There
are times when a side-by-side comparison of the results of 2 or more location groups are useful. In that case you can
mark the groups as Show All Points & then whatever source locations they can calculate will be reported. The
software will appear to sometimes produce more than one source location per event & if you look at the line display,
you will see extra event listings with the same first hit times. The extra location results will also show up as extra
points on your graphs too, but they only count as 1 event in the Statistics bar. In all cases you will see the software's
best result as one of the points. There will be times when an event cannot be located by more than 1 group, so
having Show All Points does not guarantee a result from a given location group. It is only a guarantee that you will
see it, if it can produce a useful result.
Location Type: In the next column, we have selected Tank Bottom location as the location type. By left clicking
your mouse in the Location type area on this first row, a selection box will appear with all the available location
option choices that are enabled within the software. Tank Bottom will be one of the choices, select this.
Wave Velocity: For Wave Velocity, we suggest that you use the velocity of the fluid that is in the tank as a starting
point. It is recommended you perform some tests to try to empirically determine what that actual velocity is once
you get on the tank. This can be done by creating an impact signal near one sensor, that travels from one side of the
tank to the other and monitoring the time it takes for the signal to travel the liquid path to the sensor on the opposite
side. You can then measure the time it has taken to arrive and use that with the knowledge of the diameter to arrive
at a velocity. However, you must be careful not to mistake the faster metal path arrival, traveling around the tank.
If you do not know the velocity of the fluid in the tank & cannot
easily measure it, you can access a built in Material database
within the software. To access the Materials database, simply
click the Materials button at the bottom of the Location Setup
menu. The Material Properties dialog box will appear as shown
below. Along the top of the menu, you can select what type of
materials group that you want. In our case, the liquid database
has been selected. By clicking on the down-arrow in the Material
Name text entry box, a list of materials (liquids) in our case will
be shown. Simply scroll down and select the desired material (or
liquid). In our case, we have selected Motor oil. You will note
that the velocity will automatically read out in the dis tance units
that you have selected in the Location setup menu.
If the
material selection you want is not in the database, you will be able
Figure 134. Material Properties Dialog
to enter this into the material database by using the Add
Delete and Update keys near the bottom of the Materials
database menu. You will note that for the example of the Motor oil in the figure the velocity is 5708. We can make
use of this velocity by entering it into the Wave Velocity column of the location group setup row. The direct way
is to simply left-click the cell in Location Setup, type the appropriate value into it and hit the Enter key.
Remember to enter the value in the same units as that listed at the bottom of the Location setup menu. As an
alternative, you can Copy & Paste the value by highlighting it in the Material Properties dialog box & pressing CtrlC. In Location Setup, highlight the cell, press F2 to edit its contents & then press Shift-Ins
Event Definition Value: The Event Definition Value is the length of an event in the users distance units. The
Event Definition Value should be set to make sure that an AE source, from any point in the location array, will
intersect a minimum desired number of sensors (3 is the minimum), forming an event. In our example of a 30 foot
diameter tank, we have selected an Event Definition value of 32 which assures that all the sensors in the tank will
have the capability of detecting an event regardless where it originates.
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 106 -
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
Event Lockout Value: The Event Lockout Value is also entered in the users distance units. The Event Lockout
Value controls the interval between consecutive events. Enter an Event lockout Value starting from the beginning
of the Event and long enough to assure that the there is enough time (or distance) for all additional hits and
reflections related to that event, to have had a chance to die down. In order for the Event Lockout Value to be
effective, it needs to be set longer than the Event Definition Value, since they both start at the same time. There are
no rules of thumb for setting Event Lockout Value, since the event related activity is dependent on the structure and
sensitivity settings of the system. It is best to experiment to find the best selection.
Overcal Value: The Overcal value is also set in the selected distance units and is usually set at an amount of
approximately 10% of the Event Definition Value. This is to assure that the location algorithm does not ignore
minor variations in the wavepath velocity.
Timing Strategies: The user can select from some different timing strategies as set up in the Timing tab located at
the top of the Location Setup menu. Please note that although the user can select a different timing strategy, that the
Tank Bottom location algorithm cannot support using multiple timing strategies as the other advanced location
modes can.
Hits/Event (min/max): This entry is to be used with iterative location determination strategies that are able to
process more than 3 hits for a given location. However, Tank Bottom location only uses 3 arrivals to determine
location and therefore, these fields are not adjustable.
Max Iterations: The Tank Bottom Location algorithm does not use an iterative location algorithm and therefore you
cannot enter a value in this textbox area.
Once you fill out all this information, you should proceed to the Location View menu where you can setup up the
Tank Bottom Structure and dimensions and set sensors around the tank. Meanwhile, you may change any of the
above entries at any time you want to improve the location accuracy.
4.5.3.2
The Sensor Placement dialog is entered from the Location Setup by selecting the Location View button. Upon
selecting this option, the dialog box shown in figure 132 will appear. This menu is the base starting point for
setting up the Tank bottom (and other location based) structures. The Tank Bottom is one of the easiest location
setups to perform since the sensors can be placed quickly and automatically. Please perform the following steps to
set up all the aspects required in the Sensor Placement dialog shown below.
- 107 -
1.
2.
3.
4.
4.5.3.3
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
First, make sure that you have selected the location group that you wish to work with. In our case, we had
set up location group #1 in the Location Setup menu, so make sure Group #1 is selected in the Group
selection text entry box.
Next, we go to the Structure menu and select the Tank
Bottom structure as the desired structure. This gives us a
chance to talk about our structure based location
capability. Since the user is setting up his application on a
particular type of structure (such as a plate, a pipe, a
vessel, a sphere, a tank bottom, etc., etc., it is important
for the location to think in terms of structures as well.
This is what has been implemented in the software and is
an extremely advanced concept that only PAC is doing.
Once you have selected the Tank Bottom as your
Structure type, you should then click the Dimensions
button. The dialog box shown to the right will appear.
This menu is a customized user configuration menu for
the type of structure you have selected and allows the
customer to set up certain aspects of that structure. In the
case of a Tank Bottom, the menu allows the user to enter
the Tank diameter (which we have set to 30 feet in our
example, allows you to set alternate units and also allows
you to enter information about the automatic sensor
Figure 136. Tankbottom
placement. First it lets you select the starting sensor
number as well as the total number of sensors that will be equally spaced around the tank and the starting
phase, assuming that 0 degrees is that the top of the tank bottom (or North). In our example, we have set up
for our sensors to start at sensor #1, starting at the top or 0 degrees and the placement of 12 sensors. When
accepted (by clicking the OK button), the sensors will be automatically placed in a clockwise fashion at
equal angular spacing, on a circular tank bottom in the Location View area. This allows the user to view
the spacing. Please note the table of sensor positions that is automatically generated. This table can be
exported to the clipboard (by right clicking on the grid and selecting copy to clipboard) for insertion into
a report file.
After the sensor placement step, the user should then go and set up the sensors on the tank in the locations
indicated by the Location view menu. Once done and the sensors have been connected to the appropriate
AE channel number, you are ready to proceed to the setting up the Location graph and begin acquisition.
Setting Up a Tank Bottom Location Graph
The next step in the process of getting ready for carrying out a Tank Bottom location test is to set up the Tank
Bottom Location screen. This is a straightforward process which is carried out in conjunction with the Graph Setup
menu. The following are the steps in setting up a Tank Bottom Location Graph.
1.
First, exit the Sensor Placement dialog and the Location Setup menu by clicking the OK button. Please
note that if you click Cancel that you will lose all the setup changes that you have entered. Make sure
you click the OK button before proceeding. Upon getting out of the Location setup menu, you will be back
to the main screen showing some graph setups.
2.
First, lets add a graph page by either right-clicking on one of the graph tabs at the bottom of the screen or
by clicking on the New Page icon on the icon toolbar (the icon looks like a sheet of paper). This action
will add a new tab to the bottom of the graph selection tabs and will create a blank screen. Next, lets name
the new Graph Tab, Tank Bottom by right-clicking on the tab and selecting the Rename Page selection.
3.
Next, lets add a graph to the page by either right-clicking on the new Tank Bottom tab or selecting the
New Graph icon on the icon toolbar menu at the top of the screen (its next to the new page icon). Once
you do this, a graph window will pop up. Maximize the graph to be full screen by clicking on the Tile
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 108 -
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
Horizontal or Tile Vertically icons on the top icon toolbar. You are now ready to create your Tank
Bottom Location graph.
4.
5.
6.
7.
Next, setup the Y-(vertical axis) and X-(horizontal axis) for display. First set the Y vertical axis to be a
Primary graph (this means that you will only be plotting one graph on this screen plot. The next scrolling
textbox allows you to select the feature or value that you want to plot. Since this is a location plot you want
to plot the Y position versus the X position, so select these for your Y and X settings.
8.
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 109 -
9.
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
The last important setting is to select Events as your Input data to the graph. Events will show the result of
the location determination on the incoming AE data.
10. With all these settings done, we can exit the graph setup menu by clicking the OK button. If you did
everything correctly, you will get a nice looking tank bottom screen like that shown here. If you do not
have such a nice looking screen, you should go back to the graph setup menu and make some corrections
until it is as nice looking as this one. Also note that you can have other graphs on this same screen, you are
not limited to just the one graph.
11. Note that the structure and the sensors were automatically plotted on the screen. This is because the
software was instructed that the structure of the Location group #1 was a Tank Bottom location and was
automatically able to draw this structure as soon as it saw that the graph which was being set up was an X
versus Y position location graph.
You have now totally completed the setup of a Tank Bottom location test and are ready to acquire or replay data.
4.5.3.4
Now that the entire setup is complete, you are ready to acquire
or replay data from your Tank bottom test. To acquire data,
simply enter data acquisition and begin recording data. You
should always perform a test to determine if the location
algorithm is operating properly before actually performing the
true acquisition test. Verify that the location is performing
properly and the AE hardware and software settings are all
correct to minimize noise and maximize the types of signals
you want to record. Once satisfied, start acquiring test data.
Once acquisition is completed you can start replaying and
analyzing data. There should be a Tank bottom data file in
your directory for you to experiment with. If you have this file,
it should be called TankBot.dta. There might also be a Tank
Bottom Layout file called TankBot.lay. If you have these you
can use them to test Tank Bottom
location. If you do a replay of TankBot.dta using the
TankBot.lay layout file, you should see results like that shown
here.
All standard analysis and filtering tools can be used on this data
to weed out noise and assure that you have the most relevant
data.
There is one other mode that has been built into the Tank
Bottom Software that allows multiple location calculations and
plots to be displayed on the Tank Bottom location screen. To
access this processing selection please select the Acquisition
Setup Location Tank Bottom Options selection. You
will see this selection box just above the Location View
menu selection as shown on figure 137. The resulting Tank
Bottom Options dialog box is shown here.
This option allows you to choose to display more than 1
location per event. Normally, the number is set to 1 as a
default but we have set it to 5 to allow up to 5 location
calculations per event to process and display on the screen.
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 110 -
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
This uses other hits in the event in order to calculate location in case
the first hits of the events have some problems. Note that this
option will only be displayed in replay to keep acquisition at its
highest speeds. Once this is selected and the file is replayed, you
can see the difference by comparing the graph at the right with the
one above. As can be seen, there are more events displayed the one
to the right, as there should be. What we learn by this is that the
location is pretty good and matches pretty closely telling us that the
original location data in figure is valid. This completes the setup
and operation of the Tank Bottom location.
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 111 -
5.
5.1
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
The Supervisor Option allows the user to restrict access to the software by the use of a password. With this option
installed the software will start up in Operator Mode by default.
In Operator Mode the user has limited access to the system. He can:
Load a layout file.
Print/Export graphs or copy them to the clipboard.
Change the Test Title.
Edit the Logistics Information.
Setup the Audio Monitor (if present).
Perform a test or AST.
Replay an existing data file.
Toggle the Line Listing Display on/off.
The user can switch to supervisor mode by clicking Switch to Supervisor Mode from the File menu and entering
the password.
In Supervisor Mode the user has full access to the system. He can perform all the functions possible in operator
mode plus he can:
Change the password.
Create and save layout files.
Access the various Test Setup menus.
Create, modify and delete graphs.
Modify the arrangement of the graphs, create and delete pages, etc.
How to set the password the first time. The first time the user tries to switch to supervisor mode the software will
ask for an initial password. Enter a password of your choice which must be 4-8 alphanumeric characters in length.
It is not case sensitive. From this point on the user must enter this password to switch to supervisor mode.
Note: If your system came with AEwin pre-installed and the program doesnt request an initial password, this means
that the initial password was set at the factory. The password in this case is AEwin.
How to change the password: The user can change the password by switching to supervisor mode and clicking
Change Password from the file menu.
What to do if you forget the password: If you forget the password the only way to recover is to uninstall the
software and reinstall it. This will allow you to enter a new password.
5.2
LeakTEC Alarms
LeakTEC Alarms (part of the LeakTEC/On-Line-Crack Alarm Option) are used to monitor ASL or RMS levels
(using Time Data) during acquisition and alert the user if they stray beyond certain pre-set lower and upper limits. If
ASL or RMS levels stray beyond these limits for a certain period of time an Alarm is generated.
5.2.1
Setup
If you have the LeakTEC/On-Line-Crack Alarm Option installed then you can enable and customize these alarms
by using the LeakTEC Alarm Setup dialog box located on the Acquisition Setup menu. Its controls are described
below.
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 112 -
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
5.2.2
Operation
If the ASL/RMS for a particular channel violates an alarm level (low, high or high high) and remains continuously
in violation of that level for a duration of time equal to the appropriate Hold-Off then an alarm is triggered.
5.2.3
1)
2)
3)
4)
5.3
An alarm message (16) is generated. If autodump is on then this message is saved to the datafile. If the line
display is active then it will be displayed there with the time was triggered and the conditions that triggered it.
The Alarm Display dialog box is opened (or updated if already open). The details of the alarm and the
conditions that triggered it are shown. The alarm can be cleared by clicking the Clear Alarms button.
If the alarm is an alarm warning then the Alarm Warning output line is set high. If the alarm is an alarm trip
then both the Alarm Warning and Alarm Trip lines are set high.
An audible alarm is triggered if you have an audio board installed and enabled.
On-Line Crack Alarms
On-Line Crack Alarms (part of the LeakTEC/On-Line-Crack Alarm Option) are used to monitor hits or events
during acquisition and alert the user if the hit/event or energy rates exceed certain pre-set levels. If these rates
exceed these limits within a certain period of time an Alarm is generated.
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 113 -
5.3.1
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
Setup
If you have the LeakTEC/On-Line Crack Alarm Option installed then you can enable and customize these alarms
by using the On-Line Crack Alarm Setup dialog box located on the Acquisition Setup menu. Its controls are
described below.
Channel Each channel can be
enabled/disabled
and
customized
independently.
Click a channels
checkbox to enable that channel.
Hits/Events Amplitude Threshold This
is the amplitude that a hit (or first hit of
an event) must equal or exceed in order
to be counted towards a Warning
Hit/Events or Trip Hit/Events alarm.
This does not affect energy alarms.
[Warning] Hits/Events A Hits/Events
Warning alarm will be triggered if at
least this many hits/events that meet the
Amplitude Threshold are acquired within
a period of time not exceeding the
Warning Alarm Monitor Interval.
[Trip] Hits/Events A Trip Hits/Events
alarm will be triggered if at least this
many hits/events that meet the amplitude
threshold are acquired within a period of
time not exceeding the Trip Alarm
Monitor Interval. If the logic condition
is ENERGY then this alarm type is
disabled and will not trigger. If the logic
condition is AND then the Trip Energy
condition must be met as well before an
alarm will be triggered.
[Trip] Energy A Trip Energy alarm
will be triggered if the total energy of
Figure 143. On-Line Crack Alarm Setup
any number of hits/events (with any
amplitude) are acquired within a period
of time not exceeding the Trip Alarm
Monitor Interval meets or exceeds this value. If the logic condition is Hits/Events then this alarm type is disabled
and will not trigger. If the logic condition is AND then the Trip Hits/Events condition must be met as well
before an alarm will be triggered.
[Trip] Logic Condition The logic condition controls how the Trip alarms are calculated. If it is set to Hits/Events
then the Trip Energy condition is ignored and no alarms will be triggered using it. If it is set to Energy then the
Trip Hits/Events condition is ignored and no alarms will be triggered using it. If it is set to AND then both the
Trip Hits/Events and Trip Energy conditions must be met before an alarm is triggered. If it is set to OR then
meeting either condition will trigger a Trip alarm.
Warning Alarm Monitor Interval This is the period of time in which hits/events (passing the threshold) are
accumulated towards a Warning alarm.
Trip Alarm Monitor Interval This is the period of time in which hits/events (passing the threshold) and energy are
accumulated towards a Trip alarm.
Alarm Parameter Select whether to use hits or the first hit of events for alarm determination.
Alarm Reset Setup Click this button to enter the Auto Alarm-Reset dialog box. This can be used to set the system
to automatically clear the alarms periodically.
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 114 -
5.3.2
Rev. 1.90
Chapter IV
Operation
An alarm message (16) is generated. If autodump is on then this message is saved to the datafile. If the line
display is active then it will be displayed there with the time was triggered and the conditions that triggered it.
The Alarm Display dialog box is opened (or updated if already open). The details of the alarm and the
conditions that triggered it are shown. The alarm can be cleared by clicking the Clear Alarms button.
If the alarm is an alarm warning then the Alarm Warning output line is set high. If the alarm is an alarm trip
then both the Alarm Warning and Alarm Trip lines are set high.
An audible alarm is triggered if you have an audio board installed and enabled.
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 115 -
Rev. 1.90
APPENDIX
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 116 -
Chapter IV
Utilities Menu
AEwin Software
Rev. 1.9
UTILITIES MENU
AEwin SOFTWARE
TABLE OF CONTENTS
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9.
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
-2-
Rev. 1.9
UTILITIES MENU
The utilities Submenu show the list of utility programs to help the user perform post-test analysis.
Report: Reads a Data file and creates a report containing: System Information, Test Information,
Hardware Setup as well as Alarm and Filter setup information. This is useful when making reports
of AE tests to provide full Test Setup documentation.
Statistics: Provides minimum, maximum, average and standard deviation of all features in a DTA
file.
ASCII Output: Extracts AE Feature data from a DTA file and writes it into a new ASCII format
text file.
Waveform to ASCII: Converts each waveform found in a DTA or TDA file into an ASCII text
file.
Time Order/Repair: Performs a time ordering of all messages in a DTA file and checks the file
for proper file close messages.
Link Separate Data Files: Puts together at least two data files with the header information of the
first one.
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
-3-
Rev. 1.9
Merge Continued Data Files: Puts together at least two continued data files.
Remove Messages: Removes the selected types of messages from a DTA file
Change Title: Lets the user change the title from a given DTA file.
Data File Filter: Filters a DTA files based on based on a user-defined filter.
Operators Log Management: Allows the user to view, modify, add and manipulate comment
user time marks, in a DTA file.
Time Mark and Parametric: Allows the user to view, modify, add and manipulate parametric
time marks, in a DTA file.
Split File: Lets the user to split a given DTA file into smaller DTA files.
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
-4-
Rev. 1.9
REPORT
REPORT is utility program that reads PAC, AE Multi-channel system Data (DTA) files, extracts the file
header contents, and creates a report containing; System Information, Test Information, Hardware setup,
as well as Alarm and Filter setup information. This file can be displayed on screen, saved as a text (ASCII)
file, copied or imported into a word processor file.
The Data (DTA) file includes hardware setup information and also includes Test Information as shown
below;
This utility program is very easy to use and is a very convenient way of documenting and archiving a test
setup as part of a test report or as a standalone file for later access.
Don't expect to see all the above information because not all the files have this information. In other words,
the "report" is able to read all information but the user only will see what has been saved in the file under
examination.
When the user runs this utility, the program will ask him to select the input file:
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
-5-
Rev. 1.9
If the user selects "Open" the report program immediately will begin to process the selected file, meanwhile
the user can see the progress bar at the right bottom in the main window. When the program finishes the
user will see the information about the file displayed in the report results window as shown in the following
image.
The user has the option to copy this information to the clipboard for inserting in other documents, directly
save the information in an ASCII format text file by clicking on the "Save As.." button. Or simply view the
information in the screen.
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
-6-
Rev. 1.9
STATISTICS
STATISTICS is a utility program that reads an AE multi-channel Data (DTA) file and processes the file to
provide a summary report of the AE data inside the data file in terms of number of hits for each channel,
total hits, total waveforms and time based records as well as the maximum, minimum average and standard
deviation per feature per channel.
When the user selects the option in the menu the program asks to select the input name for the data file.
The Statistics process begins when the user clicks on the "Open" button over a file (if the user clicks Open
over a folder the Open button expands the folder).
When the process finishes the user can see the statistics result window as shown below:
-7-
Rev. 1.9
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
-8-
Rev. 1.9
ASCII OUTPUT
The ASCII Output utility will convert an AE data file (.DTA) into an ASCII format text file that can be
read in word processors and spreadsheets. The program requires the user to input the file name to be
processed, the output file name and the selection of messages and data content the user is interested in
saving to the ASCII output file.
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
-9-
Rev. 1.9
This Dialog box (shown above) lets the user select which should be recorded to the resultant text file (if
existing on the file)
The user will know that the program has finished when the following message appears:
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 10 -
Rev. 1.9
ASCII WAVEFORMS
The waveform to ASCII utility processes a DTA file or a TDA file containing waveforms , takes each
waveform found in the file and saves each of them into a separate ASCII text file (Excel compatible). The
program offers the user two types of conversion: simple and complete. Simple is when the output files only
contain one column of data without any information header, meanwhile complete contains the information
header and the data column.
When the user selects to run this utility, the program will ask him the name for the input file.
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 11 -
Rev. 1.9
Now the program will ask the user to select some options for the output file.
The user can choose the Type, the file extension and the name for the output files. Type has two choices:
simple, with waveform data only and complete with waveform data and header. Complete is the default
option. The information header lists the following information:
Another option for the user is the output file extension. If he wants to analyze the data using EXCEL he
should select the "csv" extension to open directly in EXCEL without being asked to convert the file in
EXCEL. The "csv" option is the default. The "txt" output should be selected for non-EXCEL applications
and is more generic.
The last question to answer is the file name options, there are three of them: (1) channel number and hit
number, (2) channel number, hit number and time and (3) channel number and time. The second one is the
default option. These allow an automatic file naming convention for recognition and identification of the
waveform file after conversion. The user should choose the option that he feels is best.
When the program is processing the input file, the user will see the progress bar located at the right bottom
in the main window. As soon as the program finishes, the summary window will show the input file name,
the output folder with the base name and a list with the number of processed waveforms per channel.
The user can go to the output folder he selected to find the created files, one file per waveform.
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 12 -
Rev. 1.9
Figure 15. Output Folder Showing the Text Files Created by ASCII Waveform Utility
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 13 -
Rev. 1.9
TIME ORDER/REPAIR
It should be noted that in AEwin, data is already saved in a Time Ordered sequence, so time ordering is not
a necessity for data collected by AEwin. However, all DTA data files generated outside of AEwin (all DOS
based AE programs) should be processed by this utility before being replayed into AEwin.
Time Order as its name suggests is a utility to time order the messages in AE Data files. The data file
"header" is transferred to the output file unchanged. The remaining messages, which constitute the actual
data, are transferred to the output file in time order. That is, the data is sorted into order of increasing time.
Extensive error checking of the messages in the data file is provided in the process and, when possible
corrections are made.
To run Time order over a file the user will need to provide the input file name and the output file name.
- 14 -
Rev. 1.9
Link is a utility that allows the user to combine files from different tests into one file so that for all other
purposes the data will appear as if they came from a single test. A typical case where this may be desirable
might be: if for some reason a test had to be aborted and was resumed at a later time, the user will then
have two separate files, but for analysis purposes the user will need to have just one file.
When the user selects to run Link Utility from the Utilities Menu in AEwin the first window that will
appear is the one asking him about the time between files. The default value is 1 second. This time
becomes the time gap between the ending of the first data file and the beginning time of the second when
the files get linked into one.
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 15 -
Rev. 1.9
Button Actions:
Add:
Remove:
Select a file and then press this button to remove the selected file.
Remove ALL:
With this one the user can remove in one step all the files.
Doesn't have to select them.
Up:
Select the file you want to move one position before and press this button.
Down:
Select the file you want to move one position after and click on this button.
OK:
CANCEL:
After selecting the files to link and establishing the order, the user has to provide the program with an
Output file name. This file is going to be approximately, actually less than the sum of the sizes of the files
selected as input files. So when selecting the output file take this fact into account.
When the program finishes the linking, it will show the next dialog message to the user:
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 16 -
Rev. 1.9
Continued files are an option in the AEwin software which allows the user to close a DTA file based on an
elapsed time, number of hits or file size, and immediately re-open a new "continued" file with links in the
filename and data header to the previous file.
Merge is the utility that allows the user to merge multiple continued files into one large data file. The user
has to provide the input files names and order for merging them in the following window:
- 17 -
Rev. 1.9
- 18 -
Rev. 1.9
The filter (if enabled) is applied to the waveform. This may alter its arrival time and that of
any hit extracted from it.
2)
If the filtered waveform (or original if no filter is enabled) does not reach or exceed the
threshold then it and its associated hit are NOT written to the output file and the process
begins again with the next waveform and associated hit.
3)
If the filtered waveform (or original if no filter is enabled) does reach or exceed the threshold
then:
If Saving Original Waveform is selected then the original waveform and
associated hit are written to the output data file. The process begins again with the
next waveform and associated hit.
If Saving Filtered Waveform is selected then the filtered waveform is saved to
the output data file and the process continues to step 4.
4)
A new hit is extracted from the filtered waveform and is saved to the output data file. If for
some reason no hit is associated with the waveform than a new hit is NOT extracted and
written.
The input data file must have been collected using the same data acquisition board type
(AEDSP, PCI-DSP4, etc) as the version of AEwin this utility is running on. I.E. If the user is
running AEwin for DiSP then this utility can use data files created by AEwin for DiSP, DiSP
and DiSP-LOC. If the user tries to filter/extract a data file created by a different data
acquisition board type then the setup may be incompatible. If it is then an error message Error
Reading Hardware Setup, Aborted will be shown and the utility will abort.
2)
Unassociated hits (hits not associated with a waveform) are NOT copied to the output data file.
3)
The arrival times of filtered waveforms and their associated extracted hits may change during
the filter process.
4)
In order for the extracted features to be the same as the original features the waveforms must be
equal to a length defined as Pre-Trigger + Duration + HDT. If the waveform length is shorter
than this then the calculation of the features may terminate prematurely.
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 19 -
Rev. 1.9
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 20 -
Rev. 1.9
The user will be prompted to select an input data file for filtering. This utility program assumes the file is in
time order. This is a valid assumption for any DTA data file collected under AEwin acquisition software.
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 21 -
Rev. 1.9
When the user opens the input file, the Filter Setup Dialog is shown. (Figure 31)
The filter definition menu consists of five (5) groups, each of them linked by a logical condition
(AND/OR). Each group operates on a pair of conditions, linked also by a logical condition, and a set of
channels to which those conditions apply. The user can set the group ON or OFF.
To set a condition, the user selects a characteristic to look for from the drop down list, then specifies a
range by typing a lower and an upper value and also can check the "NOT" box if he wants to select the
values out of the range.
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 22 -
Rev. 1.9
When the characteristic selected is "Time", the lower and upper values should be given in seconds, but the
software provides a time converter by clicking the little button at the right top of the edit box.
To specify the channels to filter or the condition based in certain channels the user needs to click on the
"Select Channel(s)" button of the specified condition. The interface that he will see is shown in Figure 35.
At the bottom part of the filter definition menu window, the user has other options applicable to the
Waveforms and the Time Driven Data messages. Also in this section is the definition of the Filter Action.
By selecting "Reject", all the values that fulfill the condition are going to be rejected, while selecting
"Accept", all the values that fulfill the condition are going to be saved to the output file.
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 23 -
Rev. 1.9
Filter Definition Filter User Interface the user has four option buttons at the right bottom:
Run Filter. This option prompts the user for an output file name for the filtered file. Once the user
selects the file then the program runs the filter definition file to filter the input data file. While this
action is being carried out, the progress bar will indicate how much of the file has been processed;
also the name of the file in process is shown below the progress bar. This is helpful when working
with big files. A message box will appear when the process is finished.
Load Filter. This option prompts the user to recall a saved filter definition file (*.flt) to load and
use in the filter for using directly or to use it as a base to create a new filter definition.
Save as.. This option prompts the user for a name for the filter definition file (*.flt) for future
use/archiving.
Cancel. This option lets the user exit the utility without saving any changes to the filter since the
last time it was saved.
Note: The Report Utility can be used to view the history of filters applied to a data file.
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 24 -
Rev. 1.9
You will be prompted to select a data file for analysis. This utility program assumes that the file is in timeorder. Perform time ordering only if the data file was generated by an acquisition program other than
AEwin.
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 25 -
Rev. 1.9
Once loaded, a list of existing comment user time marks will appear on the Operators Log Management
screen (shown below).
Each row in the grid pertains to a single comment time mark. There are three columns.
Mod shows an indication of any changes the user has made to the time-mark.
N means that the comment time mark was just created.
M means that the comment time mark is an existing one that was just modified.
D means that the comment time mark is an existing one to be deleted.
DM means that the comment time mark is an existing one, modified and to be deleted.
Time is the time of test of the comment time mark.
Comment is the label/comment (if any) of the time mark. The maximum length of the comment is 40
characters.
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 26 -
Rev. 1.9
13.1 Modify
To change the time of test or comment of a comment time mark, select it by clicking on the row and press
Modify button. This will bring up the dialog box shown:
The Set Comment Time Mark Information
dialog box displays the original comment (if any)
and time of test. A new comment can be entered
by selecting one of the standard comments from
its drop down box or by typing a new one. You
can enter a new time in the Time of Test fields.
You can see the end time of test at the bottom of
the dialog, you should be aware of this time
because the time of test for any time mark should
be less than the end time of test. When your
changes are complete press Ok to keep your
changes or Cancel to discard them. A modified
(but non-new) time-mark will have an M in its
Mod column.
Figure 40. Modify
13.2 Restore Original
To undo a modification of a comment time mark, select the time mark row from the grid and press Restore
Original. This will remove the M from its Mod column and prevent it from being modified in a future
file update.
13.3 Add New
To add a new comment time mark to the grid press Add New. This will open the Set Comment Time
Mark Information dialog box (shown previously). Once you have set the comment and time, press Ok to
keep your changes or Cancel to discard them. The new comment time mark will be inserted in time order
to the grid, marked by an N in the Mod column. It will be added to the new file during a file update.
13.4 Copy
A quick way to create a comment time mark is to make a copy of an existing one and modify it as desired.
To do this select a time mark row from the grid and press Copy. This makes a copy of the selected
comment time mark and opens the Set Comment Time Mark Information dialog box (shown previously).
Once you have completed your changes, select Ok to keep the new time mark or Cancel to discard it.
The new comment time mark will be inserted in time order to the grid, marked by an N in the Mod
column.
13.5 Delete/Undelete
To delete a comment time mark, select the row from the grid and press Delete/Undelete. If the time mark
is a new one (marked by N) it is immediately and permanently removed from the grid. If not then a D
will appear in the Mod column, except when the time mark is a modified one (with an M in the Mod
column), for this case a DM will appear in the Mod column. This action can be undone at any time
prior to a file update. During a file update any comment time marks designated for deletion will be
removed from the new file.
To undelete a comment time mark, select it from the grid and press Delete/Undelete. This will remove
the D or DM mark from the Mod column and will prevent the comment time mark from being deleted
during a future file update.
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 27 -
Rev. 1.9
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 28 -
Rev. 1.9
You will be prompted to select a data file for analysis. This utility program assumes that the file is in timeorder. Perform time ordering only if the data file was generated by an acquisition program other than
AEwin.
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 29 -
Rev. 1.9
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 30 -
Rev. 1.9
14.1 Modify
To change the time of test, comment or parametric value of a time mark, select it by clicking on the row
and press Modify button. This will bring up the dialog box shown below:
- 31 -
Rev. 1.9
completed your changes, select Ok to keep the new time mark or Cancel to discard it. The new time
mark will be inserted in time order to the grid, marked by an N in the Mod column.
14.5 Delete/Undelete
To delete a time mark, select the row from the grid and press Delete/Undelete. If the time mark is a new
one (marked by N) it is immediately and permanently removed from the grid. If not then a D will
appear in the Mod column, except when the time mark is a modified one (with an M in the Mod
column), for this case a DM will appear in the Mod column. This action can be undone at any time
prior to a file update. During a file update any time marks designated for deletion will be removed from the
new file.
To undelete a time mark, select it from the grid and press Delete/Undelete. This will remove the D or
DM mark from the Mod column and will prevent the time mark from being deleted during a future file
update.
14.6 Parametric Range
In order to display parametric 1 in percent form, you need to set a valid parametric range. Pressing
Parametric Range will open the Set Parametric Range dialog box (shown below).
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 32 -
Rev. 1.9
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 33 -
Rev. 1.9
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 34 -
Rev. 1.9
Then the utility is going to ask the user to type the desired size for the resultant files, which has to be
specified in Kb (and for the program is taking 1 Kb equal to 1000 bytes).
Copyright 2004, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Jct., New Jersey, USA
- 35 -
AE GENERAL PRACTICES
TECHNICAL REPORT
TR-103-96-12/89
Copyright 2003 MISTRAS Holdings Group. All Rights Reserved. PAC #101402
Acoustic Emission
Other Methods
Detects movement of
defects
Requires stress
Inspection is directly
repeatable
More material-sensitive
Less material-sensitive
Less geometry-sensitive
Less intrusive on plant/
process
More geometry-sensitive
More intrusive on plant/
process
Table 1:
Range of Applicability
Acoustic emission is a natural phenomenon
occurring in the widest range of materials, structures and processes. The largest-scale acoustic
emissions are seismic events, while the smallestscale processes that have been observed with
AE inspection are the movements of small numbers of dislocations in stressed metals. In between, there is a wide range of laboratory studies
and industrial testing.
In the laboratory, AE inspection is a powerful aid to materials testing and the study of deformation and fracture. It gives an immediate
indication of the response and behavior of a material under stress, intimately connected with
strength, damage and failure. Because the AE response of a material depends on its microstructure and deformation mode, materials differ
widely in their AE response. Brittleness and
heterogeneity are two major factors conducive
ity. Although high-fidelity, flat frequency response sensors are available, most practical AE
testing employs resonant-type sensors that are
more sensitive, as well as less costly, than the
fiat frequency response type. These sensors have
one or more preferred frequencies of oscillation,
governed by crystal size and shape. These preferred frequencies actually dominate the waveform and spectrum of the observed signal in
typical AE testing.
The sensitivity calibration of AE sensors was
the subject of a substantial developmental program at the National Bureau of Standards (NBS)
through the late 1970s. This program has led to
the routine availability of NBS-traceable plots
showing the absolute sensitivity of AE sensors
in volts per unit velocity as a function of frequency (Ref 21).
Acoustic Emission Waveform Transformation.
In addition to the wave propagation factors discussed earlier, the transformation of a single AE
waveform is further compounded by the sensor
response. When a resonant sensor is excited by a
broadband transient pulse, it rings like a bell at
its own natural frequencies of oscillation. Therefore, the electrical signal at the sensor output is
the product of this ringing, thus compounding
the effects of multiple paths and multiple wave
modes by which the wave travels from source to
sensor. A typical AE signal from a piezoelectric
sensor is shown in Fig. 7; the radical difference
between this observed signal and the simple
waveform at the source (Fig. 2) cannot be overemphasized.
Instrumentation Principles
During an AE test, the sensors on the testpiece
produce any number of transient signals. A signal from a single, discrete deformation event is
known as a burst-type signal This type of signal
has a fast rise time and a slower decay, as illustrated in Fig. 7. Burst-type signals vary widely
in shape, size, and rate of occurrence, depending
on the structure and the test conditions. If there
is a high rate of occurrence, the individual bursttype signals combine to form a continuous emission. In some cases, AE inspection relies on the
detection of continuous emission (see the sections Mechanisms of AE Sources and Leak
Testing in this article).
The instrumentation of an AE inspection provides the necessary detection of continuous emissions or detectable burst-type emissions.
Typically, AE instrumentation must fulfill several other requirements:
The instrumentation must provide some
measure of the total quantity of detected emission for correlation with time and/or load and
for assessment of the condition of the testpiece
The system usually needs to provide some
statistical information on the detected AE signals for more detailed diagnosis of source
mechanisms or for assessing the significance
of the detected signals
Many systems can locate the source of detectable burst-type emissions by comparing
the arrival times of the wave at different sensors. This is an important capability of great
value in testing both large and small structures
The systems should provide a means for discriminating between signals of interest and
noise signals from background noise sources
such as friction, impact, and electromagnetic
interference
Instruments vary widely in form, function, and
price. Some are designed to function automati-
Figure 9: Acoustic emission from a welded threepoint bend specimen of 12% Ni maraging
steel. Steps in the curve are discrete,
burst-type emissions caused by plastic
zone growth and later, crack front
movement.
the load rises, the AE rate increases, and the individual events are no longer discernible on the
plot. As the specimen approaches failure, there
are multiple resets of the pen corresponding to
the generation of hundreds of thousands of AE
counts.
Hit-Driven AE Systems. All-hardware systems reached an apex of development in the late
1970s, but they were eventually superseded by
computer-based systems. The development of
AE technology coincided with the development
of computers, and computers were probably used
earlier for AE inspection than for any other NDT
method. Computers were first used for AE multichannel source location systems around 1970.
Although source location was the first task (and
a very advanced one), computers soon came into
use for the more general purposes of AE data
storage, analysis, and display. At the same time,
personnel involved in AE inspection became
interested in other signal features of burst-type
emissions beyond the threshold-crossing counts
(see the section Signal Measurement Parameters in this article).
These trends led to a new principle of AE instrumentation that has dominated the technology ever since. This principle involves the
measurement of key parameters of each hit, that
is, each AE signal that crosses the threshold. A
digital description of each hit is generated by the
front-end hardware and is passed in sequence
with other hit descriptions through a computer
system, which provides data storage, a variety
of graphical displays, and replay for posttest
analysis.
A generic block diagram is shown in Fig. 10,
and a typical modern system is shown in Fig. 11.
The larger, multichannel systems divide the dataprocessing tasks among many microprocessors.
In the system shown in Fig. 11, for example, a
separate microprocessor serves each pair of signal measurement channels. The highest priority
for this microprocessor is to read the results of
each signal measurement as soon as the measurement process is completed, so that the measurement circuitry can be reset for the next event.
The front-end microprocessor can rapidly store
Amplitude, A, is the highest peak voltage attained by an AE waveform. This is a very important parameter because it directly determines
the detectability of the AE event. Acoustic emission amplitudes are directly related to the magnitude of the source event, and they vary over an
extremely wide range from microvolts to volts.
Of all the conventionally measured parameters,
amplitude is the one best suited to developing
statistical information in the form of distribution
functions (Ref 23). The amplitudes of acoustic
emissions are customarily expressed on a decibel
(logarithmic) scale, in which 1 mV at the transducer is defined as 0dBae, 10 mV is 20dBae, 100
mV is 40dBae, and so on.
Counts, N, are the threshold-crossing pulses
(sometimes called ringdown counts) discussed
above. This is one of the oldest and easiest ways
of quantifying the AE signal. Counts depend on
the magnitude of the source event, but they also
depend strongly on the acoustic properties and
reverberant nature of the specimen and the sensor.
MARSE, sometimes known as energy counts,
E, is the measured area under the rectified signal
envelope. As a measure of the AE signal magnitude, this quantity has gained acceptance and is
replacing counts for many purposes, even though
the required circuitry is relatively complex.
MARSE is preferred over counts because it is
sensitive to amplitude as well as duration, and it
is less dependent on threshold setting and operating frequency. Total AE activity must often be
measured by summing the magnitudes of all the
detected events; of all the measured parameters,
MARSE is the one best suited to this purpose.
Duration, D, is the elapsed time from the first
threshold crossing to the last. Directly measured
in microseconds, this parameter depends on
source magnitude, structural acoustics, and reverberation in much the same way as counts. It
is valuable for recognizing certain long-duration
source processes such as delamination in composite materials (Ref 24), and it can be useful for
noise filtering and other types of signal qualification.
Figure 11: Typical general purpose AE intstrument a 24-channel data acquisition system with
computer for data display, storage, and
analysis. Courtesy of Physical Acoustics
Corporation
Figure 13(g) is a point plot of counts (or duration) versus amplitude. Each hit is shown as one
point on the display, and its position shows information about the size and shape of the waveform. This type of display is used for data quality
evaluation, specifically for identifying some commonly encountered types of unwanted noise (Ref
25). Acoustic emission signals from impulsive
sources typically form a diagonal band running
across this display. Noise signals from electromagnetic interference fall below the main band
(circled area, lower right, Fig. 13g) because they
are not prolonged by acoustic reverberation.
Noise signals from friction and leaks fall above
the main band (circled area, upper left, Fig. 13g)
because the source process is extended in time,
not a short impulse. This is only one of the many
point plots that have proved useful in practical
AE testing.
The typical software-based system can generate many displays simultaneously in memory
while the test is running, presenting them to the
Figure 13: Typical AE data displays. (a) History plot of the cumulative count or energy. (b) History plot of the count rate or energy rate. (c) History plot of AE data versus
load. (d) Cumulative amplitude distribution showing the number of hits that exceeded an amplitude. (e) Differential amplitude distribution showing the number of
hits of a particular amplitude. (f) Planar source location display. (g) Point plot of counts (or duration) versus amplitude
Noise
Precautions against interfering noise are an integral part of AE technology. Enormous progress
has been made since the early days when students worked at night, using specially constructed
loading machines in underground laboratories to
avoid disruption of their experiments by street
traffic and people moving nearby. With current
technology, many tests can be performed without special measures, and a wide range of techniques have been developed to make AE
inspection applicable in extremely noisy environments.
FR =
Figure 15: Acoustic emission energy rate (expressed as the mean square of sensor voltage) and load versus
time. Optimum formability corresponds to the lowest emissivity in a deep-drawing steel subjected to
spheroidization heat treatment. (a) Underannealed: 80% pearlite, 20% spheroids. (b) Optimally
annealed: 100% spheroids. (c) Overannealed: 30% elongated spheroids and doglegs.
larger particles interfere more strongly with dislocation motion and produce larger emissions
when fractured, so the emission peak is strong
again. It is an interesting result that the optimum
material condition is the condition of lowest
emissivity, suggesting that AE inspection could
be used for inspection and quality control of this
material as well as for research.
Acoustic emission from crack growth is of
the greatest interest for practical NDT applications of the AE phenomenon. By virtue of the
stress concentrations in their vicinity, cracks and
other defects will emit during rising load, while
unflawed material elsewhere is still silent. Acoustic emissions from crack initiation and growth
have been extensively reported in the literature.
Many of these reports deal with specialized
forms of crack growth, such as fatigue, stresscorrosion cracking, and hydrogen embrittlement
(Ref 33).
It is useful to distinguish between AE signals
from the plastic zone at the crack tip and AE
signals from movement of the crack front itself.
Growth of the plastic zone typically produces
many emissions of rather low amplitude. These
emissions are typically ascribed to the fracture
of precipitates and inclusions (for example, manganese sulfide stringers in steels), and the triaxial
nature of the stress field is implicated in the emissivity of these sources.
Acoustic emissions from crack front movement depend critically on the nature of the crack
growth process. Microscopically rapid mechanisms such as brittle intergranular fracture and
transgranular cleavage are readily detectable, even
when the crack front is only advancing one grain
at a time at subcritical stress levels. Slow, continuous crack growth mechanisms such as
microvoid coalescence (ductile tearing) and active path corrosion are not detectable in themselves, but if general yield has not occurred, they
may be detectable through associated plastic zone
growth. Quantitative theory, which explains why
some processes are detectable and others are not,
was developed by Wodley and Scruby (Ref 33).
The possibility of silent crack growth in ductile
materials caused much consternation when it was
first recognized in laboratory conditions, but it
has not been a deterrent in real-life NDT, in which
emission from defects is characteristically enhanced by environmental embrittlement, emissive corrosion products, crack face friction, or
emissive nonmetallic materials entrained in the
defect during the fabrication process.
Many fracture mechanics models have been
developed to relate acoustic emissions to crack
growth parameters. An important early approach
was to relate acoustic emissions to the plastic
zone size with the hope of estimating directly
the stress intensity factor at defects found in the
field (Ref 34, 35). Other models relate acoustic
emissions to crack tip movement in situations of
cyclic fatigue (Ref 33) or stress-corrosion cracking (Ref 36) for various materials. These models
are commonly framed as power-law rela-
Brittle compound
Failure
strain, %
0.25
0.57
0.80
0.28
0.66
0.91
Table 2:
directed toward the inspection of integrated circuits. In the early 1970s, for example, an entire
satellite launch mission failed because of a loose
particle inside the cavity of a single integrated
circuit. As a result, integrated circuits for critical
applications are now routinely tested by particle impact noise detection technology, an inexpensive derivative of AE testing (Ref 12). During
the manufacturing process, other types of flaws
in integrated circuits can also be effectively controlled with AE inspection. Acoustic emissions
from bonding processes and from ceramic substrate cracking were investigated by Western Electric researchers during the 1970s and were used
as accept/reject criteria for parts on automated
assembly lines (Ref 3).
The AE monitoring of welding processes has
been part of the technology since its early days.
Slag-free, more-automated weld techniques such
as resistance welding, laser and electron beam
welding, and gas tungsten arc and gas metal arc
welding are the easiest to monitor. In the case of
resistance welding, AE monitoring is carefully
synchronized to the weld cycle, and the various
phases of the weld process are treated separately.
Emission during solidification and cooling is correlated with nugget size and therefore with weld
strength, while high-amplitude signals from expulsions can be used to switch off the weld current at the optimum time to avoid overwelding
and to save power and electrode life. In the case
of gas tungsten arc and gas metal arc welding,
real-time computer algorithms have been developed to recognize the characteristic AE signatures of particular types of defects and to report
these defects while the weld is being made. These
procedures are effective even in the presence of
substantial background noise. Gas tungsten arc
welded injector tubes for the space shuttle are
among the welded components routinely monitored by AE inspection in the production environment.
Shaft straightening is another production process that lends itself to quality control by AE
monitoring. Forged shafts are routinely straightened in special machinery that detects any imperfections in alignment and applies suitable
bending forces to correct them. The quality of
the product is threatened by microcracking of
the hardened surface of the shaft during the bend-
ing process. Acoustic emission inspection detects this very effectively and is incorporated
into the machinery to warn personnel and to halt
the process when potentially damaging microcracking occurs (Ref 4).
In welding and shaft straightening, the stresses
that activate acoustic emissions are already
present in the normal production processes (in
welding, they are thermal stresses). In other cases,
the stress is applied for the express purpose of
AE testing. This is akin to the loadings routinely
applied for the AE inspection of new and inservice pressure vessels and other large structures. Examples include the production testing
of brazed joints (Ref 2), and the proof testing of
welds in steel ammunition-belt links described in
the following example.
Example 4: Acoustic Emission Inspection
of Projection Welds in 1050 Steel Ammunition-Belt Links. The ammunition-belt link
shown in Fig. 17(a) was made of 0.81 mm (0.032
in.) thick 1050 steel strip. The steel was preformed into link halves that were joined by two
projection welds on each side where the sections
overlapped. Although the welding schedules were
carefully controlled to produce good resistance
welds, there was a significant potential for producing some faulty welds in the mass-produced
links. In a good weld, a weld nugget is formed
that is usually stronger than the base metal in
tension; that is, the base metal will tear before
the weld will break. In a poor weld, the joint
interface is literally just stuck together, and a
moderate force, particularly one imposed by
impact, will cause the joint to fracture at the
interface. A preliminary feasibility investigation
showed that poor welds produced more acoustic
emission under load than good welds, even though
the load was insufficient to break a poor weld.
Proof-Testing Equipment. A mechanical link
tester (Fig. 17b) was designed to apply both a
shear load and a bending load to the ammunitionbelt link at the welded joints. This simulated the
service load that would be imposed on the link.
Initially, piezoelectric sensors were attached
to each link before testing to monitor acoustic
emissions. This was the simplest and most direct method of confirming feasibility. Because
attaching sensors directly to the link was not
feasible for production testing, piezoelectric sen-
Figure 16: Area plot of AE count rate versus strain. (a) Longitudinal tension test of a B(B C)/Ti-6AI-4V specimen. (b) Transverse tension test of a B(B C)/Ti-6AI-4V
4
4
specimen. (c) Transverse tension test of a SiC/Ti-6AI-4V specimen
Acoustic emission inspection has been successfully applied in the structural testing of aircraft, spacecraft, bridges, bucket trucks, buildings,
dams, military vehicles, mines, piping systems,
pipelines, pressure vessels, railroad tank cars,
rotating machinery, storage tanks, and other structures. The typical goal of an AE structural test is
to find defects and to assess or ensure structural
integrity. Acoustic emission inspection has been
described as condition monitoring of static plant
(Ref 42), which is parallel to the vibration monitoring techniques that are effectively used to
monitor the condition of rotating plant. Both of
these methods are useful for predicting failures
(Ref 43) and reducing maintenance costs.
Key to structural testing with AE inspection
are the stress concentrations that cause defects
and other areas of weakness to emit while the
rest of the structure is silent. Acoustic emission
inspection thus highlights the regions that threaten
the integrity of the structure. As a whole-structure test using fixed sensors, AE inspection is
normally complemented by other NDT methods that are used to follow up the AE findings
and to assist in determining the type, severity,
and acceptability of the AE sources.
A major advantage of AE inspection is that it
does not require access to the whole examination
area. Removal of external insulation or internal
process fluids, typically a major expense associated with other NDT methods, is not required
for the AE test. In fact, this procedure can be
avoided altogether if the AE test indicates that
the structure is in good condition.
For AE inspection to function reliably as a
whole-structure test, the structure must be loaded
in such a way as to stimulate emission from all
structurally significant defects. Continuous monitoring in service is a possible test approach that
has been applied, for example, to aircraft (Ref 7)
and nuclear reactors. This approach guarantees
appropriate stressing, but it is difficult because a
small amount of emission from defect growth
must be separated from a large amount of noise
over a long time period. More commonly, the
AE test is conducted over the course of a few
minutes or hours, during which the structure is
stimulated by applying a controlled stress (Ref
44). In most cases, this is satisfactorily accomplished by going somewhat above the normally
apparent service loads (for example, 110% of
References
1. Acoustic Emission Testing, Vol 5, 2nd ed.,
Nondestructive Testing Handbook, R.K. Miller
and P. McIntire, Ed., American Society for
Nondestructive Testing, 1987, p 275-310
2. T.F. Drouillard and T.G. Glenn, Production
Acoustic Emission Testing of Braze Joint, J.
Acoust. Emiss., Vol 1 (No. 2), 1985, p 8l-85
3. S.J. Vahaviolos, Real Time Detection of
Microcracks in Brittle Materials Using Stress
Wave Emission (SWE), IEEE Trans.,
Vol PHP-10 (No. 3), Sept 1974, p 152-159
4. K.H. Prtzel, Acoustic Emission for Crack
Inspection During Fully Automatic and
Manual Straightening of Transmission
Shafts, in Proceedings of the Acoustic Emission Symposium (Bad Nauheim), J.
Eisenbltter, Ed., Deutsche Gesellschaft fur
Metalikunde, 1988, p 157-164
5. Acoustic Emission Testing, Vol 5, 2nd ed.,
Nondestructive Testing Handbook, R.K. Miller
and P. McIntire, Ed., American Society for
Nondestructive Testing, 1987, p 167-186,
187-193
6. D.L. Parry, Industrial Application of Acoustic Emission Analysis Technology, in
Monitoring Structural Integrity by Acoustic
Emission, STP 571, American Society for
Testing and Materials, 1975, p 150-183
7. Acoustic Emission Testing, Vol 5, 2nd ed.,
Nondestructive Testing Handbook, R.K. Miller
and P. McIntire, Ed., American Society for
Nondestructive Testing, 1987, p 421-424,
434-443, 226-259, 333-339, 267-271
8. T.J. Fowler, Recent Developments in Acoustic Emission Testing of Chemical Process
Equipment, in Progress in Acoustic Emission
IV, Proceedings of the Ninth International
Acoustic Emission Symposium, The Japanese
Society for Nondestructive Inspection, 1988,
p 391-404
9. P.C. Cole, Acoustic Emission, in The Capabilities and Limitations of NDT, Part 7, The
British Institute of Non-Destructive Testing,
1988
10. Acoustic Emission Testing, Vol 5, 2nd ed.,
Nondestructive Testing Handbook, R.K. Miller
and P. McIntire, Ed., American Society for
Nondestructive Testing, 1987, p 278, 472484, 213-219
11. S.L. McBride, Acoustic Emission Measurements on Rubbing Surfaces, in Proceedings of
the World Meeting on Acoustic Emission
(Charlotte, NC), Acoustic Emission Group,
March 1989
Acoustic Emission
Innovation, Since 1968:
24-channel Portable AE DiSP
Sensors and Systems
TANKPACTM Technology for ASTs
MONPAC Technology for pressure vessels
VPACTM for valve loss detection
AE Training Schools &
Certification
AE/NDT R & D
4-channel AE System for your PC
Services
Feasibility Studies
NDT Instruments,
Systems and Services:
Ultrasonic (UT) Imaging
Systems
UT PC Boards and Accessories
Large Structure UT Inspection Systems (LSITM)
UT Tube Inspection Systems (TubeScanTM)
Eddy Current Digital Workstations
Resistivity Material Testing Equipment
HQTS: 195 Clarksville Road Princeton Jct., NJ 08550 Phone: (609) 716-4000 Fax: (609) 716-0706 Email: sales@pacndt.com Internet: www.pacndt.com
Subsidiaries: Cambridge (44) 1954-231612 Paris (33) (1) 4982-6040 Tokyo (81) (3) 3498-3570 So Paulo (55) (11) 3082-5111 Athens (30) (210) 284-6801
Moscow (7095) 200-39-85 Beijing (86) (10) 8497-3570 Buenos Aires (54) (11) 4345-0400 Wolfegg (49) (75) 272312 Rotterdam (31) (10) 245 0325
Representatives: Worldwide.
APPENDICES
INDEX
Appendix I.
Appendix II.
Appendix III.
APPENDIX I
System Timing Parameters (PDT, HDT, HLT)
APPENDIX I
System Timing Parameters (PDT, HDT, HLT)
This appendix describes the purpose and functioning of the three timing parameters used in AE waveform
measurements:
PEAK DEFINITION TIME (PDT) Formerly known as Rise Time - Time Out (RTTO)
HIT DEFINITION TIME (HDT) Formerly known as Single Channel Event Time-Out (SCETO)
HIT LOCKOUT TIME (HLT) Formerly known as Re-arm Time Out RTO)
This appendix also offers methods for selecting values of these parameters for practical AE testing.
APPENDIX II
Data File Definition for AEwin
APPENDIX II
DATA FILE DEFINITION FOR AEwin
This document gives the format of the AEwin data files. These files are created by the AEwin when acquiring data in
AUTODUMP mode. When data is dumped to disk, a file specified by the user, with the extension .DTA (e.g.,
TEST0000.DTA) is created.
The data file consists of three basic types of variable length messages. These messages are (I) Products Definition
Messages (II) Test Setup Messages and (III) Messages from the test. Each message has two bytes for length, 1 byte for
ID (2 bytes for ID followed by 2 bytes for format version number in messages with ID41 to 44 only) and a variable
length body. The messages 41-44 are special messages in that they are also included in the INI files.
APPENDIX II
1.
2.
3
4.
Introduction
General Message Information
Detailed Message Description
AE Characteristics List
Summary
1
2
6
10
31
Rev. 2
Copyright 2005, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Junction, New Jersey, USA
-1-
Rev. 2
Copyright 2005, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Junction, New Jersey, USA
-2-
Rev. 2
Type
Id
II
III
III
III
III
V
IV
IV
IV
IV
IV
IV
IV
41
7
99
44
42
128
1
2
3
7
130
129
15
Product Definition
Test Label
Time of Day of start of test
Location setup message
Hardware setup message
Start/Resume test
AE hit data
Time Driven data
Sample data
User Comment
Test Pause
Test Stop
Test Abort message
Message Format
Each message has two bytes for length and a body of that length of bytes. Thus the total length of the "transmission" is
Length+2 bytes. The body of the message starts with a message id byte. Unfortunately it was felt that the software
would be easier if the messages which "define" the file (Presently they have ID values from 40 to 49) if the ID space
was an integer quantity. In fact, because the files contain messages with 1 byte id values, all the message IDs should be
identified by the byte value. The legal range for an ID is 1 to 255.
Special setup files would contain only (primary) messages with 2 byte ID values for example the ".INI" files for setup
of LOCAN 420, MISTRAS or SPARTAN 2000 data acquisition and replay. I would expect that we will expand this
concept to at least the post test filtering programs when they have to be coded to save and restore user setup
information.
The INI file contains the messages:
41
42
43
44
45
46
7
Product Definition
Hardware Setup
Graph Setup
Location Group Setup (even in non-location versions)
Acquisition Control
Auto Run
Test Title
49
and possibly:
In order to help the user to understand the structure of various types of messages, a set of them from the data file header
will be briefly described. This should help to explain the message concept and give a good idea of the structure of a
DTA or INI file.
Copyright 2005, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Junction, New Jersey, USA
-3-
Rev. 2
b1, b2
b1= 4
(29H)
b2= 00
PVERN
b1= 200 (C8H)
b2= 00
Prod_string "LOCAN-AT",CR,LF
,"VERSION 2.00",CR,LF
number, CR,LF
2 bytes
Product Definition Message ID
high byte of ID (2 bytes)
Product version number (200)
(2 bytes)
ASCII Product name, Carriage
Return, Line Feed, Version
b1, b2
b1=7 (07H)
b1
|
|
bn
2 bytes
User Comments or Test Label
Text in ASCII
EN
b1, b2
ID
b1= 99 (63H)
"Sun Jul 03, "
(For Example)
"08:49:55 1988"
2 bytes
Time and date of test start ID
ASCII date string,
ASCII time and year string.
ID 44 Location Definition
(Dummy message in Non-Location version)
LEN
ID
b1, b2
b1= 44 (2CH)
b2= 00
2 bytes
Location Definition ID
high byte of ID (2 bytes)
The MISTRAS DTA file also includes two TRA setup messages when the wave forms are being recorded.
ID 42 Hardware Setup
LEN
b1, b2
2 bytes
Copyright 2005, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Junction, New Jersey, USA
-4-
ID
b1=
b2=
b1=
(0
MVERN
b2= 00
Rev. 2
42 (2AH)
00
200 (C8H)
filled)
Hardware Setup ID
high byte of ID (2 bytes)
Message version number
LSUB 1
SUBID 1
SUBMSG 1
|
|
LSUB I
SUBID I
SUBMSG I
|
|
LSUB n
SUBID n
SUBMSG n
________________
Note: Submessages are:
Start of Test Setup
Set Sampling Interval
Set Demand Sampling Rate
Pulser Rate
Event Data Set Definition
Demand Data Set Definition
Group Definition
Alarm Definition
AE Filter Definition
Group Parametric Assignment
Group Settings
End of Group Settings
End of Setup
ID
ID
ID
ID
ID
ID
ID
ID
ID
ID
ID
ID
ID
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
100
27
102
133
5
6
106
28
29
110
111
124
101
(
(
(
(
(
(
(
(
(
(
(
(
(
64H
1BH
66H
85H
05H
06H
6AH
1CH
1DH
6EH
6FH
7CH
65H
)
)
)
)
)
)
)
)
)
)
)
)
)
Copyright 2005, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Junction, New Jersey, USA
-5-
Rev. 2
dB
2 sec
1 sec
1 msec
Copyright 2005, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Junction, New Jersey, USA
-6-
Rev. 2
CID
V1
|
V1
|
|
Vm
|
Vm
PID1
V1
V2
V3
PIDj
V1
V2
V3
b1, b2
b1=1 (01H)
b1
b2
|
|
b6
b1
2 bytes
AE Hit ID
Relative time of test
AE Channel Number
b1
|
bn
|
|
b1
|
bx
b1
b2
b3
(b4)
|
|
b1
b2
b3
(b4)
Copyright 2005, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Junction, New Jersey, USA
-7-
Rev. 2
PID1
V1
V2
(V3)
PIDj
V1
V2
V3
CID
V1
.
V1
|
|
Vm
.
Vm
|
|
CID
V1
|
V1
|
|
Vm
|
|
Vm
b1, b2
b1 = 2 (02H)
b1
b2
|
|
b6
b1
b2
b3
(b4)
|
|
b1
b2
b3
(b4)
b1
2 bytes
Time Driven ID
Relative time of test
b1
.
bn
|
|
b1
.
bx
|
|
b1
b1
|
bn
|
|
B1
|
|
bx
Copyright 2005, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Junction, New Jersey, USA
-8-
Rev. 2
b1, b2
b1 = 4 (04H)
b1
eb1
|
ebX
2 bytes
GCC detection of error
Error identification
Error information. May be text
or garbled message from ICC.
Error Codes
b1 = 1
eb1...ebX
b1 = 2
eb1...ebX
b1 = 100 and
200-203
b1, b2
b1=5 (05H)
b1
2 bytes
Event Data set definition ID
Number of AE characteristics
b1
|
b1
Value of CHID 1
Value of CHID m (last one)
Value of CHID m (last one)
b1
Copyright 2005, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Junction, New Jersey, USA
-9-
Rev. 2
Size
Item
2
2
2
2
4
1
1
1
1
1
1
4
2
Tentative Assignments
14
15
16
2
6
(4)
This is clearly a system with expansion capability, but we will need to try to do the expansion
in an intelligent manner.
b1, b2
b2
b1=6 (06H)
b1
2 bytes
High byte value
Demand Data Set Definition ID
Number of AE char. in the demand data set
V1
|
|
Vn
# PID
V1
|
|
Vn
b1
|
|
b1
b1
b1
|
|
b1
First CHID
Last CHID
Number of Parametric in user
First PID
Last PID
Copyright 2005, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Junction, New Jersey, USA
- 10 -
Rev. 2
b1, b2
b1=7 (07H)
b1
|
|
bn
2 bytes
User Comments or Test Label
Text in ASCII
b1, b2
b1=8 (08H)
b1
|
|
b8
2 bytes
File continuation
Time & Date of continuation in DOS
format so that 'gaps' in time in the
continuation can be detected.
{CX,DX of DOS Time, CX,DX of DOS
Date INT 21 DOS calls.}
b1, b2
b1=8 (08H)
b1
|
|
b8
{complete setup record from
the first file of the test}
2 bytes
File continuation
Time of continuation in DOS format
exactly the same as written at the
end of the preceding file.
This is all the messages up to the "Start Test Command" which were written at the beginning of the first file. If
that file were to be unavailable, then this allows this file to be analyzed.
Copyright 2005, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Junction, New Jersey, USA
- 11 -
Rev. 2
b1, b2
b1=11 (0BH)
2 bytes
Reset Absolute Time Clock
b1, b2
b1=15(0FH)
b1
b2
|
|
b6y
2 bytes
Abort data acquisition/transfer ID
Relative time of test
ID 16 Alarm Data
LEN
ID
RTOT
Level
AID
CID
V
b1, b2
b1=16(10H)
b1
b2
|
|
b6
b1
b1
b1
b1
b2
b3
b4
2 bytes
Alarm message ID
Relative time of test
ID 17 Reserved
ID 18 Reserved
Copyright 2005, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Junction, New Jersey, USA
- 12 -
Rev. 2
ID 19 Reserved
ID 21 Reserved
ID 22 Set Threshold
LEN
ID
ID
CID
V
b1, b2
b1= 22 (16H)
2 bytes
Set threshold value (dB) ID
b1
b1
Which channel
byte value for threshold
(MSBit = 1 float, = 0 fix)
ID 23 Set Gain
LEN
ID
ID
CID
V
b1, b2
b1= 23 (17H)
2 bytes
Set gain value (dB) ID
b1
b1
Which channel
1 byte value for gain
b1, b2
b1= 24 (18H)
b1
b
b2
2 bytes
Set Hit Definition Time (mS) ID
Which channel
low byte value
high byte value in steps of 2 mS
b1, b2
b1= 25 (19H)
2 bytes
Set Hit Lockout Time (mS) ID
b1
b1
b2
Which channel
low byte value
high byte value in steps of 2 mS
Copyright 2005, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Junction, New Jersey, USA
- 13 -
Rev. 2
b1, b2
b1= 26 (1AH)
b1
b1
b2
2 bytes
Set Peak Definition Time (mS) ID
Which channel
low byte value
high byte value in steps of 1 mS
b1, b2
b1= 27 (1BH)
b1
b2
2 bytes
Set the sampling interval (mS) ID
low byte value
high byte value in steps of 1 mS
ID 28 Alarm Definition
LEN
ID
j
Alarm #
CID
Type code
CHID #
Level 1
Level 2
b1, b2
b1= 28 (1CH)
b1
b1
b1
b1
b1
b1
b2
b3
b4
b1
b2
b3
b4
2 bytes
Alarm definition ID
Number of alarm definition sent
Which one is being defined
Which channel
Type of alarm
AE characteristic used
Warning level
|
Trip level
j times
ID 29 AE Filter Definition
LEN
ID
k
Filter #
CID
Type code
CHID #
Level 1
Level 2
b1, b2
b1= 29 (1DH)
b1
b1
b1
b1
b1
b1
b2
b3
b4
b1
b2
b3
2 bytes
AE filter definition ID
Number of filter definitions sent
Which one is being defined
Which channel
Type of filter (scsh only)
AE characteristic used
Low level
High level
Copyright 2005, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Junction, New Jersey, USA
- 14 -
Rev. 2
b4
k times
b1, b2
b1 = 30
TYPE
INDHITS
LOW
HIGH
EDT
2 bytes
Location definition ID
1 byte # of filter definitions to follow
1 byte Delta-T filter ID number
1 byte Board number (2 channels per board)
0 = all boards
1 = first board (channels 1,2)
2 = second board (channels 3,4),etc
1 byte
type of delta-T operation
= accept events (hit pairs) with
delta-T between LOW and HIGH
reject other events
Only one type presently defined
1 byte
independent hit control
0 = reject independent hits
delta-T over CAL)
1 = accept independent hits
4 bytes Low level in usec (signed long integer)
4 bytes High level in usec (signed long integer)
4 bytes Calibration time in usec (unsigned long)
FS times
ID 31 Reserved
ID 32 Reserved
ID 33 Reserved
ID 34 Reserved
ID 35 Reserved
ID 36 Reserved
- 15 -
Rev. 2
(INI file)
LEN
ID
MVERN
TOT
SZPW
b1, b2
b1 = 37
2 bytes
Location
1 byte =
6 bytes
n bytes
definition ID
Message version*100 e.g., V1.00=100
(least significant first) Time of hit
Zero terminated string
ID 38 - Test Information
(INI and DTA files)
LEN
ID
MVERN
ENEDIT
EDISPF9
ZTITLE
SZFIELD
1, b2
1 = 38
2 bytes
Location definition ID
1 byte = Message version*100 e.g., V1.00=100
1 byte Enable edit of title fields
1 byte Enable display of test info.at start of test
n bytes Zero terminated string title
n bytes Zero terminated string field
b1,
b1=
b2=
b1=
b2=
a1
a2
a3
|
|
an
b2
41 (29H)
00
pv#
00
2 bytes
ASCII Product Definition ID
high byte of ID (2 bytes)
Product version number (2 bytes )
MESSAGE FORMAT=100*Product ID ONLY FOR THIS ONE
SCII Product name, Carriage return,
Line feed, Version number, Carriage
return, Line feed
ID 42 Hardware Setup
LEN
ID
b1, b2
b1= 42 (2AH)
b2= 00
2 bytes
Hardware Setup ID
high byte of ID (2 bytes)
Copyright 2005, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Junction, New Jersey, USA
- 16 -
MVERN
Rev. 2
b1= fv#
b2= 00
LSUB 1
SUBID 1
SUBMSG 1
|
|
LSUB I
SUBID I
SUBMSG I
|
|
LSUB n
SUBID n
SUBMSG n
ID
ID
ID
ID
ID
ID
ID
ID
ID
ID
ID
ID
ID
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
=
100
27
102
133
5
6
106
28
29
110
111
124
101
(
(
(
(
(
(
(
(
(
(
(
(
(
64H
1BH
66H
85H
05H
06H
6AH
1CH
1DH
6EH
6FH
7CH
65H
)
)
)
)
)
)
)
)
)
)
)
)
)
b1, b2
b1= 43 (2BH)
b2= 00
MVERN
b1= fv#
b2= 00
Product Specific Information
2 bytes
Graph Definition ID
high byte of ID (2 bytes)
Message version number (2 bytes )
ID 44 Location Definition
(if found in a non-location data file, length is 1 or 2).
LEN
ID
b1, b2
b1= 44 (2CH)
b2= 00
MVERN
b1= 200 (C8H)
b2= 00
Product Specific Information
2 bytes
ocation Definition ID
high byte of ID (2 bytes)
Message version number (2 bytes )
Copyright 2005, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Junction, New Jersey, USA
- 17 -
Rev. 2
b1, b2
b1= 45 (2DH)
b2= 00
MVERN
b1= fv#
b2= 00
Product Specific Information
2 bytes
Location Definition ID
high byte of ID (2 bytes)
Message version number (2 bytes)
b1, b2
b1= 46 (2EH)
b2= 00
MVERN
b1= fv#
b2= 00
Product Specific Information
2 bytes
Location Definition ID
high byte of ID (2 bytes)
Message version number (2 bytes)
ID 47 Reserved
b1,
b1=
b2=
b1=
b2=
b2
48 (30H)
00
fv#
00
Text follows
2 bytes
Location Definition ID
high byte of ID (2 bytes)
Message version number (2 bytes)
Product specific subkeys & maybe some product
specific keys (see Appendix A, Part 1)
b1, b2
b1= 49 (31H)
b2= 00
MVERN
b1= fv#
b2= 00
Product Specific Information
2 bytes
Location Definition ID
high byte of ID (2 bytes)
Message version number (2 bytes)
Copyright 2005, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Junction, New Jersey, USA
- 18 -
Rev. 2
ID 50 Reserved
ID 51 Reserved
ID 52 Reserved
ID 53 Reserved
ID 54 to ID 98 Not Used
See 59 (V1.8) and C.E. specific MIDs
b1, b2
b1= 59 (3BH)
2 bytes
Turn off alarm
2 bytes
Time and date of test start ID
ASCII date string,
ASCII time and year string.
b1, b2
b1= 100 (64H)
2 bytes
Begin Setup ID
b1, b2
b1= 101 (65H)
2 bytes
End of Setup ID
, b2
= 102 (66H)
2 bytes
Set Demand Sampling Rate ID
Multiple of Parametric Sampling Rate)
Copyright 2005, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Junction, New Jersey, USA
- 19 -
Rev. 2
b1, b2
b1= 106 (6AH)
b1
b1
b1
b1
2 bytes
Define a group ID
Which group
How many channels IDs in list
First channel id
b1
Last channel
ID 107 Reserved
b1, b2
b1= 110 (6EH)
b1
2 bytes
Group parametrics assignment ID
Number of PIDs to follow
First PID
b1
Last PID
b1, b2
b1= 111
2 bytes
Group settings ID
Number of group messages
Body of first message (ID # = 22-26)
Body of second message
Last body
b1, b2
b1= 124 (7CH)
2 bytes
End of group message ID
Copyright 2005, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Junction, New Jersey, USA
- 20 -
Rev. 2
ID 125 Internal
ID 126 Internal
ID 127 Internal
2 bytes
Resume/start a test ID
RTOT
b1
b2
|
|
b6
2 bytes
Stop the test ID
Relative time of test
2 bytes
Pause the test ID
Relative time of test
Copyright 2005, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Junction, New Jersey, USA
- 21 -
Rev. 2
b1
b2
131 (
a1
a2
a3
a4
b1
b2
Message ID
Prod ID or
version.
Prod Ver
Length of body
H)
MID byte
ASCII Prod ID code (byte 1)
byte 2
byte 3
byte 4
Product Version Number (16 bits)
b1, b2
b1=131
b1
b2
b3
b4
b1
b2
b1
b2
b3
b4
b1
b1
b1
|
|
bn
b1
STAT
AECH
PCH
2 bytes
Status report message ID
GCC version string (e.g., V1.8)
1 In Setup
5 Waiting
2 Setup Done
6 Test Paused
3 T.O.T cleared
7 Stopped
b1, b2
b1= 133 (85H)
b1
b2
2 bytes
Pulser rate in milliseconds ID
low byte of rate
high byte of rate
Copyright 2005, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Junction, New Jersey, USA
- 22 -
Rev. 2
ID 134 Reserved
ID 135 Reserved
b1, b2
b1= 136
2 bytes
AFID
b1
HFS
HPF1
HPF2
|
|
HPFk
LFS
LPF1
LPF2
|
LPFn
b1
b2
b2
b2
b1
b2
b2
b2
Copyright 2005, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Junction, New Jersey, USA
- 23 -
Rev. 2
b1, b2
b1 = 137
2 bytes
1 byte
1 byte
+
Highpass code
1 byte
Lowpass code
1 byte
NOTE: the AFID number is ignored by the AEDSP board, which will just take the highpass and lowpass
selection codes and set the plug-in filter control lines to these codes.
b1, b2
0
1
2
3
=
=
=
=
x
x
x
x
2 bytes
1 byte
1 byte
1
10
100
1000
Filter code
1 byte
0 = no filter
1 = filter ON
2 bytes
1 byte
2 bytes
1 byte
Copyright 2005, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Junction, New Jersey, USA
- 24 -
Rev. 2
LEN
ID
Sub-ID
b1, b2
b1 = 173
b1 = 29
2 bytes
Message ID
Submessage ID
1
1
1
1
CHID
LOW
HIGH
byte
byte
byte
byte
SETS
SLEN
TRA setup 1
CHID
HLK
HITS
b1, b2
b1 = 172 (ACH)
b1 = 42 (2AH)
b1 = 100
b2 = 0
b1
b1 = n
b2
b1
b2
b1
b1
b2
b1
2 bytes
Message ID
Message sub-ID
Message version number, 100 is V 1.00
A/D converter data type
2 = 16 bit signed (only type currently defined
for MI-TRA)
Number of TRA channels (setups)
Size of hardware setup, in bytes
Copyright 2005, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Junction, New Jersey, USA
- 25 -
b2
b1
b2
b1
b2
b1
b2
b1
SRATE
TMODE
TSRC
TDLY
b2
b1
b2
b1
b2
MXIN
THRD
TRA setup 2
|
TRA setup n
Rev. 2
ID 172,134 - Reserved
b1, b2
b1 = 173
b1 = 1
2 bytes
Message ID
Submessage ID
6 bytes (least significant first) time of hit
1 byte
Channel number
1 byte
Alignment byte (dummy)
2 bytes Number of 16-bit samples following
s1
s2
|
sN
2 bytes
2 bytes
2 bytes
Last sample
AEF
- 26 -
LEN
ID
VID
b1
b2
|
|
bn
b1, b2
b1
b1
Rev. 2
2 bytes
Message ID byte
Version of the current message
TRUE/FALSE flag Controls which event plot is shown
not used
struct graph_def array defines the special graphs
b1, b2
b1
b1
2 bytes
Message ID byte
Version of the current message
First byte of the information which contains
the user setting to control the b-value
calculations.
ID 199 Internal
b1, b2
b1= 211 (D3H)
b1
b2
|
|
bn
2 bytes
Time mark ID
Relative time of test
IF LEN = (5 or) 7, then the 211 message is a plain time mark message.
IF LEN >7, then it is a SPARTAN-AT style Extended time mark. Version
1.54 and higher of the mGCC will send to the high end gain and threshold
changes with the Time Of Test stamp.
Copyright 2005, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Junction, New Jersey, USA
- 27 -
Extended message:
Rev. 2
Short Hand
Length of Message
Message ID
= 206
SubFunction Code [0-8]
subfunction body
_____________________________
SubFunction 0:
Velocity conversion Factor
DW
Value
SubFunction 1:
DW
DW
DW
DW
Opt.[ DW
DW
]
SubFunction 2:
DW
DW
Opt.[ DW
]
SubFunction 3:
W
SubFunction 4:
W
TW
W
SubFunction 5:
W
SubFunction 6:
SubFunction 7:
SubFunction 8:
W
Display Limits
Value {Horiz. Low Lim}
Value {Horiz. High Lim}
Value {Vert. Low Lim}
Value {Vert. High Lim}
Value {Depth Low Lim}
Value {Depth High Lim}
Sensor Position
Horiz. Value
Vert. Value
Depth Value
Event Data
+1 Start -1 Stop
Channel Timing
CID (Channel ID)
6 byte Time
Time to Peak
Turns ON/OFF S100 Data Display
1 == ON , else OFF
Special 3-D algorithm control values
Special 3-D setup Command to Draw
Either (1) All Sensors or (2) Last one
Use Rise Time in 3-D location calculate
1==Yes, 0==No
ID 255 Reserved
ID 255 Reserved
Copyright 2005, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Junction, New Jersey, USA
- 28 -
Rev. 2
4. SUMMARY:
Condensed System Messages & Commands
Id
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
910
11
12
1314
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
3336
37
38
3940
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
Description
AE hit/Event Data
Time Demand Data
Sample/Last Time Demand Data
GCC detected an error condition.
Hit Data Set Definition
Time driven/Demand Data Set Definition
User Comments/Test Label
Continued File Mark
Not Used
Reset Real Time Clock
Reserved
Not Used
Abort acquisition/transfer
Alarm Data
Reserved
ICC self test (Internal)
Single ICC Reset (Internal)
{Reserved for pre-amp gain}
(AST messages)
Set Threshold
Set Gain
Set Hit Definition Time
Set Hit Lockout Time
Set Peak Definition Time
Set Parametric Sampling Time
Alarm Definition
Filter Definition
AEDSP Delta-T AE Filter Definition
Reserved
High end Alarm Detected (Internal)
Reserved
INI Write-Protect Password
Test Info
Reserved
ASCII Product Definition
Hardware Setup
Graph setup ( *.ini file Only)
Location Setup
Acquisition Control Information
Auto Run Message
Reserved
Post Filter Definition and Information
Product Specific Setup & Configuration Information
Reserved
Reserved
Copyright 2005, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Junction, New Jersey, USA
- 29 -
Rev. 2
Id
Description
52
53
5458
59
6098
99
100
101
102
103105
106
107
108109
110
111
112123
124
125
126
127
128
129
130
131
132
133
134
135
136
137
138
139
140170
171
172
173
174196
197
198
199
200203
204210
211
220-221
222-254
255
Reserved
Reserved
Not Used
Ignore Alarm" - HE command to mGCC
Not Used
Time and Date of Test Start
Begin setup
End Setup
Set Demand Data Sampling Rate
Not Used
Begin a Group Setup
Reserved
Not Used
Define Group Parametric Channels
Group Parametric Settings (msgs 22-26)
Not Used
End of Current Group Setup
Internal
Internal
Internal
Begin Test
Stop Test
Pause Test
Configuration report [PRODUCT SPECIFIC]
Status report [PRODUCT SPECIFIC]
Pulser Rate
Reserved
Reserved
Analog Filter Definition (INI and DTA Files only, AEDSP software)
Analog Filter Selection (INI and DTA Files only, AEDSP board)
Analog Parametric Setup (INI and DTA Files only, AEDSP board)
Cycle Counter Analog Setup (INI and DTA Files only, AEDSP board)
Not Used
TRA2.5
TRA212
AEDSP waveform recording
Not Used
Screen template for display of omproved b-value data
Improved b-value calculation definition
Internal
Not Used
Reserved
Time Mark (also in the MONPAC and Transportion Instrument)
Reserved {Boeing}
Not defined
Reserved
Copyright 2005, Physical Acoustics Corporation, Princeton Junction, New Jersey, USA
- 30 -
APPENDIX III
System Defect Report
APPENDIX III
System Defect Report
This report is designed for you to communicate to Physical Acoustics any defects that you may
encounter in your system so that we can take corrective action. If you encounter any defects,
please send the information to PAC on a copy of this form. Thank you.
Group Headquarters:
195 Clarksville Road
Princeton Junction, NJ 08550
Phone: (609) 716-4044 Fax: (609) 716-0706
7/11/06
Software ____
(Check One)
Name:____________________________
Date:___________
Company:___________________________________________
Address:____________________________________________
___________________________________________________
___________________________________________________
Phone:___________________________
Fax:___________________________
Software Title:_______________________________
Version #:_________________